WSS Welding Handbook 2013 Full Lowres
WSS Welding Handbook 2013 Full Lowres
WSS Welding Handbook 2013 Full Lowres
12th edition
Revision 0
Notice: All welding is carried out on the welders own risk and account. Welding should be executed by a qualified and experienced
welder and adequate safety measures should always be adhered to. The information and guidelines in this Welding Handbook are based
on general information and knowledge at hand and are believed to be accurate and reliable, but the information and guidelines are not
to be taken as a guarantee or warranty for a special purpose. The information and guidelines are provided to the welder solely for his
own consideration, and Wilhelmsen Ships Service AS assumes no legal responsibility or liability for eventual damages and/or losses
should the information and/or guidelines turn out to be incorrect or un-suitable. Wilhelmsen Ships Service AS is not liable for any loss or
damages whatsoever and howsoever arising which is due to force majeure, other events beyond the reasonable control of Wilhelmsen
Ships Service AS or events that could not reasonably be foreseen by Wilhelmsen Ships Service AS when this Welding Handbook was
made. Wilhelmsen Ships Service AS is in no event liable for indirect, incidental or consequential damages or losses, including dam-
ages for loss of profits, resulting from lack of conformity, including but not limited to loss resulting from goods or software not working
when connected to other goods/software or for any related cause thereto. Wilhelmsen Ships Service ASs liability shall in any event
not exceed the total purchase price of theWilhelmsen Ships Service AS goods used during the welding operations. These conditions
are automatically accepted by anybody using the information and guidelines in this Welding Handbook.
INTRODUCTION
A ship at sea depends upon the knowledge, skills and self-reliance of the crew to carry
out necessary maintenance and repair work. One of the important skills required is a
good command of modern welding techniques.
The purpose of the Welding Handbook for maritime welders is to provide guidance
in modern welding and related processes and to provide the welder with a source of
practical information on the right solution to specific onboard welding problems.
Experience gained from user contact and welding training of crewmembers showed that
documentation aimed specifically at on board welding solutions was needed. This led
to the development of the first welding handbook for on-board repair and maintenance
welding already the 1950es.
This edition of the UNITOR Welding Handbook builds upon all the earlier editions and on
Wilhelmsen Ships Services business activity.
Wilhelmsen Ships Service AS enjoys close co-operation with its customers and
would like to thank the many who have taken the effort to contribute with examples of
successful solutions to real life maintenance situations.
UNITORWELDING HANDBOOK
UNITORWELDING HANDBOOK
UNITORWELDING HANDBOOK
UNITORWELDING HANDBOOK
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
1.00
SAFETY IN WELDING
1.00
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
How to use the handbook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Welding instructions and training . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Personal protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Work site protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Welding fumes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Safety check list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
SAFETY IN WELDING
Introduction
1.00 Welding and related thermal proc- performed by qualified personnel
esses utilize compressed gas and/or under proper supervision.
electric current to provide a con- In this chapter as well as in other parts
centrated heat source which melts of the handbook, you will find guide-
or burns away steel and other met- lines on safe handling of equipment,
als. Proper safety precautions are how to protect yourself, and safety
required to avoid accidents related precautions that should be observed
to the gas and power supplies, to the when welding and related thermal
sparks, heat, fumes, and visible and processes are used on board a ship.
invisible rays from the heat source.
You will also find extensive informa-
Authorities in most countries have tion on how and where to use filler
laid down regulations and guidelines materials, and some guidelines as to
related to welding and other hot work identifying metals.
processes, their application onboard
ships, the equipment to be used and This handbook, however, cannot be
the protection of the operator. considered to be a complete manual
for each of these areas, dealing in
These regulations must be available detail with all the aspects of the vari-
onboard, and be known and adhered ous items.
to when hot work is to be done.
Additional information
A welded component that fails may
represent a safety hazard to crew, should be sought in other publications
ship and cargo. Classification soci- from Wilhelmsen Ships Service, from
eties and other authorities have authorities and others and by attend-
consequently issued regulations and ing training courses. Approved Unitor
welding procedures for a number of welding courses will deal in detail
applications onboard. These should not only with the technique required
be known and followed wherever for a successful weld, but also with
applicable, and welding should be the safety aspects around welding
onboard.
10
SAFETY IN WELDING
The process
Before commencing work, take the time to check the details of the equip-
ment and the technique you should use from the section on processes. You should
also read through the special instruction manuals for the process and equipment
you are going to use.
11
SAFETY IN WELDING
Unitor Welding Centre Oslo, Norway Norwegian Training Centre Manila, the Philippines
Contact: weldingschool.norway@wilhelmsen.com Contact: training.manager@ntcm.com.ph
Phone: + 47 67 58 45 50 Phone: +632 8120 742
Internet site: www.wilhelmsen.com/shipsservice Internet site: www.ntcm.com.ph
Unitor Welding Centre Piraeus, Greece Consolidated Training Systems Inc Manila, The Philippines
Contact: wss.greece.cs@wilhelmsen.com Contact: marketing@ctsi.com.ph
Phone: + 30 210 4239 100 Phone: + 632 5240 572
Internet site: www.wilhelmsen.com/shipsservice Internet site: www.compass.com.ph
International Maritime Training Centre Mumbai, India People Soft Inc. Antipolo, the Phillippines
Contact: imtc.mumbai@wilhelmsen.com Contact: dbjaurigue@sourceasia.biz
Phone: +91 22 2570 5570 Phone: + 632 4210994 & 421-0998
Internet site: www.imtcmumbai.org
12
SAFETY IN WELDING
Personal protection
Why do you need protective equipment? 1.00
13
SAFETY IN WELDING
1.00
Arc welding face shields and glasses
A welder should bear in mind that proper protection is absolutely necessary to
guard himself against the danger of electric shocks, burns, ultra-violet rays and
bits of welding slag in the eye.
Unitor face shields for welding are made from a lightweight, robust plastic
material which is unaffected by heat, cold or moisture, and both glasses and
shields conform to relevant EN standards.
Replaceable inside and outside protective lenses, headband and sweatband for
the headband is available as spares. The shield is equipped with a light powered
quick automatic darkening glass that switches from low shade (4) to selected
shade within to selected dark state within 0,4 milliseconds (0,0004 sec)The low
shade state allows for good vision while chipping slag, grinding and repositioning
for next arc striking.Dark mode is adjusted with a knob at the side of the shield,
from shade 9 to 13 which is from the lowest TIG welding settings (5-10A) to
extreme processes at + 400A arc current.
14
SAFETY IN WELDING
Face shields
15
SAFETY IN WELDING
16
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
1.00
17
SAFETY IN WELDING
18
SAFETY IN WELDING
Glasses for gas welding and cutting Items to be mounted into Unitor face
The Unitor gas welding glasses shield in the following manner: 1.00
have a diameter of 50 mm and fit
the goggles. They are available in A B A
different grades of shade for various
types of work. All glasses come in
sets of 10 pcs.
A. Protection glass
When using goggles with a flip-up
front frame, the protection glass
should be placed in the fixed
frame.
A. Protection glass
One protection glass must be
placed in front of the filter shade
glass in the flip-up front frame in
order to protect against spatter.
Guide to gas welding glasses The protection glass should be
replaced at regular intervals.
Application Filter Pcs/ Product
Shade set number
Glass
Silver
Brazing 3 10 176-633305
Gas Welding 5 10 176-633313
& Cutting
General 6 10 176-633321
Gas Welding
& Cutting 7 10 176-633354
Thick material
Protection Glass 10 176-633297
19
SAFETY IN WELDING
1.00
F
C
B
D
I
G
H
20
SAFETY IN WELDING
21
SAFETY IN WELDING
22
SAFETY IN WELDING
Fire extinguisher
Always keep a fire extinguisher ready 1.00
when welding outside workshop. The
PP3P is a lightweight ABCdry powder
fire extinguisher.
Technical Properties
This device was designed using
highly reliable materials and the
latest corrosion-resisting protection
technologies In order to be ideally
suited to the requirements of the
maritime environment.
It complies with European AENOR
- EN 3 standard, and is of the hightest
performance in its category. Weight:4,7 kg.
Efficiency
Classes A, B or C Instructions for use
The multi-purpose nature of the ABC
powder extinguisher ensures that it
is effective against these three types
of fire. For solid material fires (class
A), it replaces the conventional water
products, which are sometimes not
recommended for use with electrical Temperature limits: -20 C to +60 C
currents. For liquid, liquefiable solid
and gas fires, it acts in the same
conditions as the BC powder and is Product Pcs. Product no.
ideally suited for Industrial hazards. PP3P 1 291-667394
Extinction Mechanism
The multi-purpose ABC powder acts:
-on the flames, by negative catalysis,
-on the embers, by cooling and
forming a layer of heat insulating and
fireproof varnish, which coats the
fire, preventing it from re-igniting.
When sprayed, the ABC powder forms
an insulating screen, which protects
the user from heat radiation.
Easy to use pressing on the striking handle. The
flow rate is controlled by the tap on
0peration the final control valve. The fact that it
Once the safety pin has been is so simple to use means that risks of
removed, the device is pressurised by incorrect use are greatly reduced.
23
SAFETY IN WELDING
24
SAFETY IN WELDING
25
SAFETY IN WELDING
Welding fumes
1.00 All Unitor Electrodes are issued a fume Class number according to Danish
standard. These are the recommended precautions .
Fume Class 1: Ensure sufficient ventilation when welding in confined
spaces. Other protective measures are normally not needed
in larger well ventilated spaces.
Fume Class 2: Spot extraction is always recommended when welding in
confined spaces. Larger spaces shall be well ventilated.
Fume Class 3: Spot extraction is recommended when welding indoors.
Special protective measures are normally not needed
outdoors if there is enough wind or draught to keep fumes
and gases from the welders breathing zone.
Fume Class 47: Spot extraction shall be used when welding indoors. For
outdoor welding see Fume Class 3.
The standards state the connection between Fume Class and NHL* that is a
theoretical value to describe the amount of fresh air needed to dilute the fumes
to "safe" concentrations. It is important to understand that NHL* is a theoretical
value and should not be used for calculating ventilation capacities:
26
SAFETY IN WELDING
Automatic start
When the welding cable is placed in a slit on top
of the unit the automatic start/stop function can
be used and the unit will automatically switch on
when welding starts and off when welding stops.
27
SAFETY IN WELDING
Technical Data
1.00 Number of motors 2
Motor power consumption 2x1kW
Power supply 1phase 230V 50/60Hz Dimmensions
Noise level 70dB
High vacuum suction 22 000 Pa
Extraction volume speed setting 140 m3/h
low
Extraction volume speed setting 230m3/h
high
Filter surface main filter 12 m2
Filter surface HEPA filter 0,4 m2
Filter efficiency incl. HEPA filter 99,9%
Min. operating temperature 5C
Max. operating temperature 40C
Max. relative humidity 80 %
IP class 50
Net weight 16 kg
Ordering information
Description Product no.
FumeClean 230 complete with 2,5 m 196 735878
hose and nozzle with magnet foot
Optionals
Bulkhead Bracket 196 740399
Hose Connection Outlet Side 196 740381
Active Carbon Filter 196 740431
Spare parts
Disposable Cartridge Filter 196 740415
High Efficiency Particle Filter H12 196 740423
Funnel Nozzle With Magnetic Foot 196 740373
Extract/Exhaust Hose 2,5 M, 196 740449
45 mm
Connection Piece For Two Hoses 196 740456
45 mm
Carbon Brushes 2 Sets W. Seals 196 740407
230V
28
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
1.00
29
SAFETY IN WELDING
Equipment
Check that the power source
functions correctly, is correctly
connected to mains, and that you
are familiar with its operation.
Ensure that gas cylinders are
Keep your welding equipment well properly secured, in upright
maintained. position, and fitted with correct
and properly functioning
regulators for the gas. Acetylene
and oxygen regulators shall be
fitted with flashback arrestors.
Protect cylinders against heat and
mechanical damage.
The valve opening of the acetylene
cylinder shall point away from
other compressed gas cylinders,
and a heat resistant mitten shall be
available.
Hoses shall be in good condition,
without leaks or damage, and with
correct colour coding for the gas.
(Red for acetylene, blue for oxygen,
black for shielding gases and filt
ered air). Use correct hose conn
ectors and hose clamps. Pieces of
Never use defective welding cables. pipe and twisted wire must never
be used. Never use oil or grease in
connection with welding gases and
never use copper in connection
with acetylene.
Cables shall be of oil resistant
type with undamaged insulation
and properly mounted cable
connectors. Use safety cable
connectors where both halves are
protected to prevent contact with
deck when disconnected.
30
SAFETY IN WELDING
Work place
Tidy up the work place and remove any flammable
materials, liquids and gases from workplace and adja-
cent spaces including spaces above/below decks,
behind bulkheads and inside pipes or containers. Cover
any openings through which sparks may be led to other
areas onboard which have not been prepared for hot
work.
31
SAFETY IN WELDING
1.00
32
SAFETY IN WELDING
1.00
33
ADDITIONAL WELDING LITERATURE AVAILABLE:
1.00
Cylinder safety Protect your gas cylinders and Safety checklist for welding
ID no 811049 equipment and related thermal processes
ID no 806123 ID no 811053
Welding Consumables The solutions guide Unitor The solutions guide Unitor
Selector cold polymer repair maintenance and repair
ID no 804006 ID no 804004 welding
ID no 804005
For latest product updates, approvals, user instructions and further technical details, please refer
to our online product catalogue at http:// wssproducts.wilhelmsen.com
34
SOLUTIONS
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Quick reference for cutting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
2.01
Quick reference for joining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Quick reference for rebuilding, hardfacing and coating . . . . . . 43
Quick reference for cold repairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Filler material consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Metal identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Unalloyed/low alloyed steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Problem steels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Austenitic Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Ferritic Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Martensitic Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Duplex Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Clad Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Stainless Steel corrosion types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Storing and handling of Stainless Steel onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Grinding/cutting consumables for Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Cast iron . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Copper and copper alloys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Aluminium brass (Yorc albro) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Bronze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Nickel bronzes (Cunifer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Aluminium . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Evaluation of weelds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Typical welding faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Inspection of welded joints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Crack detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
35
SOLUTIONS
Introduction
This chapter is intended to be a quick A successful solution is dependent
reference for finding alternative not only on choosing the right filler
2.01 solutions to specific problems, material, but also on the electric
indicating the process and filler power and gas supply of correct
material which should be used. quality and sufficient quantity but
All solutions are linked to one of the also that the equipment used is the
symbols below which relates the right one for the job. The overview
solution to filler material type, process on power/gas supply, equipment and
and gas/power supplies. processes show these relations.
AC/OX Cutting
AC/OX Heating
Plasma Cutting
36
SOLUTIONS
P
0
W G
E A
R S
S S
U U
P P
P P
L L
Y Y
E E
Q Q
U U
I I
P P
M M
E E
N N
T T
A A
N N
D D
P P
R R
O O
C C
E E
S S
S S
E E
S S
37
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.01
38
SOLUTIONS
2.01
ALLOY
Mild steel A 1
B C A 2
Low alloy/
cast steels A 1
B C A 2
High alloy/
stainless
steels
B C A 0
Cast iron B C A 0
Copper
with alloys B C A 0
Aluminium
with alloys B C A 0
Comments
A0: Best solution. Thickness limitation aprox. 30mm for portable
equipment.
A1: Best, most flexible solution, also for thicker materials, thickness
limitation 100 mm or 500 mm with optional nozzles.
A2: Good solution. Thickness limitation aprox. 30mm for portable
equipment.
B: Good solution for groove preparation, especially in cracks in
combination with MMA weldlng.
C: Best method for fast, efficient removal of old welds and weld
residues, and also for large scale groove /crack preparation.
39
SOLUTIONS
Unalloyed/ Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Nife (E) 23/14 (E) Tensile (E) LH (E)
Lowalloyed/ Tinbro (E) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Nickel (E) Tensile (E) Impact (E) LHV (E)
Cast *) **) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Impact (E) *) **) LHT (E)
Steels Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) *) **) Albronze (E) *) LHL (E)
*) **) *) **) *) **) *) **) *) **) ***)
Problem Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Tensile (E) Tensile (E) Tensile (E)
Steels Tinbro (E) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Nickel (E) Impact (E) Impact (E)
*) **) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) *) **) *) *)
Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) *) **)
*) **) *) **) *) **)
Stainless Icuni (W) AG-60 AG-60 AG-60 AG-60 Tensile (E) 18/8Mo (W)
Steels Tinbro (E) AG-45 AG-45 AG-45 AG-45 23/14 (E) 23/14 (E)
23/14 (E) 18/8 (E) 18/8 (E)
*) *) Duplex (E)
Iduplex (W)
*)
Cast Nickel (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Nife (E)
Iron Tinbro (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Nickel (E)
Albronze (E) *) **) *) **) *) **) *) **) Tinbro (E)
*) **) Albronze (E)
*) **) ****)
Copper Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W)
*) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E)
Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) *) **) Albronze (E)
Albronze (E) Albronze (E) *) **)
*) **) *) **)
40
Quick reference for joining
Cunifer Stainless Problem Unalloyed/
METAL Nickel
Bronze Yorcalbro Brass Copper Cast Iron Low alloyed/
Steels Steels
Alloys Cast Steels
Unalloyed/ Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Nife (E) 23/14 (E) Tensile (E) LH (E)
Low alloyed/ Tinbro (E) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Nickel (E) Tensile (E) Impact (E) LHV (E)
Cast *) **) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Impact (E) *) **) LHT (E)
Steels Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) *) **) Albronze (E) *) LHL (E)
*) **) *) **) *) **) *) **) *) **) ***)
Problem Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Tensile (E) Tensile (E) Tensile (E)
SOLUTIONS
Steels Tinbro (E) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Nickel (E) Impact (E) Impact (E)
*) **) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) *) **) *) *)
Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) *) **)
*) **) *) **) *) **)
Stainless Icuni (W) AG-60 AG-60 AG-60 AG-60 Tensile (E) 18/8Mo (W)
Steels Tinbro (E) AG-45 AG-45 AG-45 AG-45 23/14 (E) 23/14 (E)
23/14 (E) 18/8 (E) 18/8 (E)
*) *) Duplex (E)
Iduplex (W)
*)
Cast Nickel (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) Nife (E)
Iron Tinbro (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Albronze (E) Nickel (E)
Albronze (E) *) **) *) **) *) **) *) **) Tinbro (E)
*) **) Albronze (E)
*) **) ****)
Copper Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) Icuni (W) Icuni (W)
*) Icuni (W) Icuni (W) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E)
Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) *) **) Albronze (E)
Albronze (E) Albronze (E) *) **)
*) **) *) **)
Brass Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Icuni (W) Ialbro (W)
Tinbro (E) Tinbro (W) Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E) E = Coated electrode
*) Albronze (E) *) **) Albronze (E) W = Welding wire/rod
*) **) *) **)
Yorcalbro Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) Ialbro (W) *) Also capillary brazing with AG-60 and AG-45 (AG-60 only for Yorcalbro).
Tinbro (E) Icuni (W) *) **) Also brazing with FC-bronze (Bronze) or FC-Wearbro for surfacing.
*) **) Tinbro (E) ***) For unalloyed steel MS wire, and coated electrodes GPO, GPR, SPECIAL
Albronze (E)
*) **) and GPR are additional alternatives.
****) Cast Iron components that may be heated evenly may be braze welded
Bronze Icuni (W) Ialbro (W) with FC-Cast iron.
Tinbro (E) Tinbro (E)
*) **) Albronze (E)
*) **) Aluminium welding: Coated electrode: Alumin
Welding Wire: Alumag
Cunifer Icuni (W)
41
Nickel *)
Alloys
2.01
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.01
42
SOLUTIONS
Examples of applications
Wearmax (E) Wearmax (E) Abratech-330 (E)
Tensile (E) Tensile (E)
Chain, rope, wire drum Spot welds on ladder steps Cargo grab teeth
FC-Wearbro (B) Tensile (E) Impact (E)
Impact (E)
43
SOLUTIONS
44
SOLUTIONS
2. Where hot work like welding is not permitted due to fire / explosion hazard.
Cold repair systems are cold-curing processes. There is no risk of heat ignition
or sparks.
45
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.01
46
SOLUTIONS
2.02
For steel welding wires and rods
the deposit weight given equals the
a meashure Section Deposit Deposit
weight of filler material required. size volume weight
per m. per m.
The approximate deposit weight in a s V W
kg for aluminium is found by multi
mm mm 2 cm 3/m kg/m
plying the deposit volume by 0.0027.
2 4 6 0.05
The approximate deposit weight in 2.5 6.5 8.5 0.07
kg of copper alloys is found by multi 3 9 12.5 0.10
plying the deposit volume by 0.009. 4 16 21 0.16
5 25 31.5 0.25
For coated electrodes the required 6 36 42 0.33
7 49 57 0.45
number of electrodes (for steel) is 8 64 73.5 0.58
found by dividing the deposit weight 9 81 94 0.74
10 100 114 0.89
by the value (number of electrodes 11 121 138 1.08
per kg. weld metal found in the 12 144 162 1.27
13 169 190 1.49
data table for each electrode in the 14 196 224 1.76
filler material section. 15 225 248 1.95
47
SOLUTIONS
2.02
50 Flat 70 Vertical
Plate Root Deposit Deposit Plate Root Deposit Deposit
thickness opening volume weight thickness opening volume weight
per m. per m. per m. per m.
t s V W t s V W
60 Flat 80 Vertical
Plate Root Deposit Deposit Plate Root Deposit Deposit
thickness opening volume weight thickness opening volume weight
per m. per m. per m. per m.
t s V W t s V W
mm mm cm 3/m kg/m mm mm cm 3/m kg/m
4 1 13 0.10 4 1 17.5 0.14
5 1 19.5 0.15 5 1 26 0.22
6 1 27 0.20 6 1 36 0.30
7 1.5 39 0.30 7 1.5 51.5 0.44
8 1.5 49 0.37 8 1.5 65.5 0.55
9 1.5 60.5 0.44 9 1.5 81.5 0.69
10 2 77.5 0.57 10 2 104 0.86
11 2 92 0.66 11 2 124 1.02
12 2 107 0.77 12 2 145 1.23
14 2 141 1.02 14 2 193 1.60
15 2 160 1.15 15 2 219 1.81
16 2 180 1.23 16 2 247 2.02
18 2 223 1.60 18 2 308 2.51
20 2 271 1.94 20 2 376 3.11
25 2 411 2.94 25 2 577 4.76
48
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.02
49
SOLUTIONS
Metal identification
2.03
Test Appearance of Appearance of Appearance of Comparative Other tests for
untreated metal surface after filling fracture surface weight of metal identification,
surface and relative see following
toughness pages for
Metal description
Grey cast iron Dark grey or Light grey, rather Dark grey, Heavy Chiselling test.
rusty. smooth. uneven granular
Rough granular surface.
surface. Rather brittle.
White cast iron As above Normally too hard Very finegrained, Heavy None
to file. Shiny white silvery crystalline
when polished. surface.
Very brittle.
Unalloyed steel. Dark grey or rusty, Shiny grey, very Medium-grey Heavy File test. Spark
wrought iron, can be smooth or smooth surface. colour. Very tough test. Magnet test.
low-alloy steel, rough, depending Some alloys are to very brittle, Chisel test
carbon steel on field of unfilable. depending on type.
application.
Stainless steel Shiny silver-grey Shiny silver-grey. Fine-grained grey Heavy Magnet test
if polished. Matt Smooth surface. surface. From
grey if unpolished. Some are not tough to brittle.
filable.
Brass and bronze Various grades of From bronzered to Not necessary Heavy None
yellow-brown or Yellow, smooth
green-brown. surface.
Aluminium and Very light grey Very white and Not necessary Very light Acid test
aluminium alloys smooth surface.
Lead and white White to grey, White, very Not necessary Very heavy None
metal smooth velvety smooth shiny
surface. surface.
50
SOLUTIONS
Filing test
Spark test
This test may be carried out in the ships workshop and is very useful for
identifying the type of steel and determining its approximate carbon content.
Hold a sample lightly against the grindstone and note the shape, colour and
length of the sparks. Unalloyed and low alloyed steels are difficult to tell apart,
but when tested together it is comparatively easy to see the difference.
Chisel test
Unalloyed The sparks separate at the
steel end into several small sparks
(leaf shaped). Some sparks
are short.
High speed Weak red sparks, with forked Unalloyed steel (Cast steel).
steel ends. Long (continuous) shavings are formed
when chiselled.
51
SOLUTIONS
Magnetic
Indicates a Ferritic normal steel.
If stainless steel: poor weldability.
If unalloyed / low-alloyed steel:
good weldability.
52
METAL IDENTIfICATION
MAGNETIC TEST
No Spark Sparks Cuts easily Hard Oxy cuts Won't oxy cut
SOLUTIONS
Copper, Austenitic Monel OxY CUT TEST Low alloy & plain Cst irons,
brasses, Manganese and carbon steels Chromium steels,
bronzes, lead, Stainless Steel High alloy tool and
lead-tin, zinc Oxy cuts Won't cut die steels, Nickel
alloys
Aluminium OxY CUT TEST Work hardened Work hardened
alloys Aust. Mang. steel Aust. stainless or
Magnesium & hard ferrite
alloys Oxy cuts Won't oxy cut stainless
53
2.03
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.03
54
SOLUTIONS: Unalloyed/low alloyed steel
Introduction
Steel can be generally classified steel, weather steel, and tool steel.
as an alloy of Ferrum (Fe), better On board a ship we find this type
known as iron, and carbon (C). Iron of steel in hullplates, frames, deck
is the main component in most types plates, deck beams and bulkheads. A
of steel. Steel is classified in three common composition of this type of
grades: steel is (%):
Unalloyed steel (containing
up to 1% alloy elements). This C Mn Si
type of steel is also termed mild
steel, carbon steel and carbon
0.18 1.30 0.40 2.04
manganese steel.
Al P S
Low alloy steel (containing 15%
alloy elements). 0.057 0.02 0.03
55
SOLUTIONS: Unalloyed/low alloyed steel
Weathering steel
For welding of heat resistant steel, Weathering steel can be exposed to
filler material with heat resistant the weather without being painted.
deposit only may be used. Selection of Good corrosion resistance to
the correct electrode for the job will seawater and flue gases. This type of
depend on the percentage of Mo and steel contains Copper and Nickel.
Cr in the alloy. LHT and ICROMO are Use LHR electrode for welding.
Standard construction steel, high strength steel, manganese steel and hardwearing steel
Steel Tensile Yield Elong- Hardness C Si Mn P S Cr Cu N Ni Mo
quality strength N/mm2 ation HB
Nmm2 % % % % % % % % % % % %
Max.
St 42-C 412490 235 22 0.22 0.5 0.05 0.05 0.3 0.4 0.009
St 42-D ca. 130 0.2 0.5 0.05 0.05 0.3 0.4 0.009
St 52-C 510608 314 21 ca. 150160 0.2 0.5 1.5 0.05 0.05 0.3 0.4 0.009
St 52-D 0.18 0.6 1.6 0.04 0.04 0.3 0.4 0.009
MN-steel ca. 700 ca. 400 ca. 25 ca. 200 1.2 0.6 12.5 0.35
56
SOLUTIONS: Unalloyed/low alloyed steel
Joining galvanized
steel pipes forming a FC-
V-butt joint, rounded BRONZE-261
edges on the joint.
BRONZE-264
57
SOLUTIONS: Unalloyed/low alloyed steel
General purpose
repair welding of GPO-302N
unalloyed steel parts. SPECIAL-303N
LH-314N
LHV-316N
Fabrication of GPO-302N
smaller steel parts
like shelves, ladders
SPECIAL-303N
and gangways in
unalloyed steel.
LH-314N
58
SOLUTIONS: Unalloyed/low alloyed steel
Welding repairs of
low alloyed ship SPECIAL-303N
building steel used in
the hull, beams, deck, LH-314N
bulkheads, stiffeners,
tanks, holds, hatch
covers, frames etc. LHV-316N
LHV-316N
Welding on cranes
and lifting equipment. SPECIAL-303N
LH-314N
LH-316N
TENSILE-328N
59
SOLUTIONS: Unalloyed/low alloyed steel
SPECIAL-303N
Welding subject to
high loads (Lifting, LH-314N
lugs, etc.).
LHV-316N
TENSILE-328N
Weathering steel
used for sea-water
and flue gases. LHR-320N
Low temperature
applications. Ice-
class hull plates. LHL-319N
60
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.04
61
SOLUTIONS:Problem Steels
62
SOLUTIONS:Problem Steels
2.05
63
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.05
64
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
Introduction
Stainless steel belongs to the high Carbon increases strength, but in
alloy steel group. connection with stainless steel and
Chromium (Cr) is the element that in amounts above 0,04% it will cause
makes stainless steel stainless or chromium carbide formation (chrome
corrosion resistant. The chromium carbide particles) between 430-
combines with oxygen and creates 870C. The chrome carbide cannot
an invisible though impregnable combine with oxygen to create
chromium oxide on the surface. chrome oxide. This reduces the
It must contain at least 11,5% corrosion resistance in local areas
chromium, that is the content at leading to intergranular corrosion.
which an effective layer is formed The carbon content in stainless
that seals the surface against any steel materials and consumables are
therefore kept at
2.06
further atmospheric corrosion.
a very low level.
Many stainless alloys contain larger
amounts of chromium for further By chemical composition or heat
improving corrosion resistance and treatment, or a combination, the
to increase resistance to oxidation at stainless steel receives one of the
high temperatures. following micro structures when
manufactured: Austenitic, Ferritic,
Nickel (Ni) in excess of about 6% Martensitic or Ferritic/Austenitic.
increases corrosion resistance
slightly and greatly improves The American Iron and Steel Institute
mechanical properties. Small (AISI) established a numbering
amounts of Molybdenum (Mo) system to classify the stainless
increase resistance to pitting type steel alloys. The AISI classifies
corrosion and general resistance to stainless steel by their metallurgical
certain corrosive media. Stainless structures. This system is useful
steel alloy with molybdenum is because the structures (Austenitic,
therefore referred to as acid ferritic or martensitic) indicates the
resistant. Molybdenum also improves general range of mechanical and
high temperature strength. physical properties and weldability.
65
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
23/14-322N (E)
309 0,20 22,0 24,0 12,0 15,0
309 S 0,08 22,0 24,0 12,0 15,0
S-309-M-GF-222
(W)
310 0,25 24,0 26,0 19,0 22,0 1,5 Si
310 S 0,08 24,0 26,0 19,0 22,0 1,5 Si IMPACT-329S
314 0,25 23,0 26,0 19,0 22,0 1,5 3,0 Si (E)
18/8-321N (E)
316 0,08 16,0 18,0 10 14,0 2,0 3,0 Mo
316 L 0,03 16,0 18,0 10 14,0 2,0 3,0 Mo
S-316-M-GF-221
316 N 0,08 16,0 18,0 10,0 14,0 1,0Si 2,0Mn 2,0-3,0Mo 0,10-0,16Ni (W)
66
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
Some limitations:
Austenitic stainless steel has some
limitations:
The maximum temperature under
oxidizing conditions is 925C. Crossed weld joints are undesirable. In
general welds must not be located too
They are suitable only for low
close to one another.
concentrations of reducing acid.
In crevices and shielded areas,
there might not be enough oxygen
to maintain the passive oxide film
and crevice corrosion might occur
(Duplex are available in these
situations).
Very high levels of halide ions,
especially the chloride ion can also
break down the passive surface
film.
67
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
AISI May be
Type Composition % * welded with:
(E) Electrode
2.06 Carbon Chromium Manganese (W) Wire Welding
C Cr Ni Other
405 0.08 11.5 14.5 1.0 0.1 0.3 AI
409 0.08 10.5 11.75 1.0 Max 1.0 Si Max, Ti min. 6 x C, 0.045 S, 0.045 P
429 0.12 14.0 16.0 1.0 1.0 Si
430 0.12 14.0 18.0 1.0 23/14-322N (E)
439 F 0.12 14.0 18.0 1.25 0.060 P, 0.15 S (min), 0.60 Mo (opt)
430Fse 0.12 14.0 18.0 1.25 0.60 P, 0.060 S, 0.15 Se (min)
434 0.12 16.0 18.0 1.0 0.75 1.25 Mo, 1.0 Si
436 0.12 16.0 18.0 1.0 0.75 1.25 Mo, (Cb+Ta) Min 5 x % C, 1,0 Si
439 0.07 17.75 18.75 1.0 0,6 Si 0,5 Ni, 0,15 AI, Ti 12 x C (1.0 max)
442 0.20 18.0 23.0 1.0 1,0 Ni, 1,75 2,5 Mo, 0,035 N max S-309-M-GF-222
444 0.025 17.5 19.5 1.0 (Cb+Ta) min 0,2 + 4 (%C+%N) 0,25 N (W)
446 0.20 23.0 27.0 1.5 0,75 Ni, 0,75 15 Mo 0,2 10 Ti
26-1 0.06 25.0 27.00 0.75 0,04 Ni, 0,2 Cu 0,025, 0,75 Si
0,015 Ni, 3,5 4,2 Mo 0,15 Cu
29-4 0.01 28.0 30.0 0.3 0,02 Ni, 0,2 Si, 0,025 P, 0,02 S
2,0 2,5Ni, 3,5 4.2 Mo, 0,15 Cu
29-4-2 0.01 28 30.0 0.3 0,02Ni, 0,2 Si, 0,025P, o,025 S
68
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
69
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
Duplex stainless steel has good weldability but great care must be taken
to use the correct consumable and to follow the welding procedure.
70
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
71
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
72
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
Crevice corrosion
73
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
74
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
75
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
INOX, disc with soft grit bonding for cutting and grinding on soft metals.
Contains no free iron and the aluminium oxide grit used contains very small
amounts of bonded iron.
Iron free (inox) grinding discs is to have less than 0.10 % content of iron,
chlorine and sulphur compounds.
2.06
76
SOLUTIONS: Stainless Steel
Fibre discs (sanding paper)
Should be used in connection with plastic backing pads.
Fibre discs contain Aluminium oxide grit with resin bonding. Applicable on
stainless steels.
Disadvantage: frequent change of fibre discs.
Mop discs
Sanding paper flaps mounted on backing plate.
The abrasive flaps contain alumina zirconia with resin bonding.
Contains no free iron.
Very suitable for stainless steel grinding and polishing.
Provides very smooth surfaces due to the flexibility of the disc.
The fan pattern improves cooling during operation.
Mop disk
Mop discs for SS
Grit: Aluminium zirconia, iron free
Bonding: Resin
Applications: Grinding on almost any metal, incl. stainless steel, hardened
and alloy steel, aluminium, wood, paint, plastics etc.
77
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Introduction
To approach welding of cast iron, shrinkage, high damping capacity on
the special properties of this vibrations and ready machinability.
material must be understood, and But the carbon is also source of
the techniques for joining it together problems. Due to its high content
followed. the cast iron is brittle and has very
Welders who attempt to repair cast little elongation when subjected to
iron based upon their experience from strain. Because of this it cracks easily
welding steel, and on the assumption when subjected to local heating and
that " iron is iron" often end up with cooling, as is the case when welding.
a poor result without understanding Thus the welding properties of cast
why. iron differ from those of steel.
Hence, cast iron repairs has been a While steel melts at approximately
2.07 feared operation to welders. 1450C, the high carbon content of
cast iron lowers the melting point to
However, many grades of cast iron
11001300C (depending on type),
can indeed be welded successfully.
making it easier to melt and allowing
Cast iron is essentially an alloy of it to run freely into a mold to assume
ferrum (iron), carbon and silicon. The the shape intended for the casting.
carbon content ranges from 2.4% On boars ships cast iron has found
up to 4.5%, which means that it is wide uses as for instant engine
present in excess of the amount that blocks, heads, liners, water jackets,
can be contained in solid solution. transmissions, pump and valve
Although up to 6% of carbon can housings, manifolds, pipe fittings,
be dissolved in iron when molten, cargo lines, etc.
actually less than 1.75% can remain in
There are five common types of cast
solution when the metal solidifies. The
iron:
excess carbon separates out during
solidification and remains present and
Grey
dispersed throughout the cast iron in
White
the form of free carbon (graphite).
Malleable
Two of the factors, which influence Ductile
the amount of carbon, that separate High alloy
out when the cast iron solidifies are
the length of time it takes to solidify
These different cast irons cannot be
and the amount of silicon that is
identified by chemical analysis alone.
present. Silicon tends to drive out any
It is the form of the excess carbon that
carbon in solution as graphite if it is
determines the kind of iron that the melt
given enough time and temperature.
becomes. With regard to the fifth type,
Thus the percentage of free graphite
high alloy cast iron, this is obtained by
is a function of the cooling rate.
adding quantities of alloying elements
This excess carbon is the reason for to gray, white or ductile irons. In the
many of the desirable properties of following we shall take a look at the
cast iron, such as high fluidity, low characteristics of the various types.
78
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
79
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Iron Carbides
80
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
81
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Characteristics:
High density
Very high strength
Fair weldability
82
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Shaving
Mild steel
Cast iron
Unalloyed steel (Cast steel).
Faint red streaks terminating in complex bushy
sparks yellow in colour.
83
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
84
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
2.07
File after grinding
Searing
The more carbon you can remover
from the weld area, the less chance
there will be for hard spots in the
weld. To further remove excess
carbon embedded in the surface the This gives a cleaner surface.
workpiece can be seared, using an
oxy-acetylene torch with an oxidising
(excess oxygen) flame.
Use a lager blowpipe and move the
inner cone of the flame forward over
both sides of the welding groove. You to put too much heat into the material
will know immediately when the free when executing it.
carbon is removed. As the carbon Regardless of what we do to remove
burns it looks like a bright red particle surface graphite, some graphite
or "star". Use a wire brush over the will nevertheless be melted up and
surface from time to time. become part of the weld. Unitor cast
Searing must not be confused with iron electrodes are so made that
preheating, and is only intended to they can take up 1% graphite without
remove surface carbon. Take care not causing the formation of iron carbide.
85
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
86
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Unitor NICKEL-333N
For use on old, oil-impregnated cast 2.07
iron and on thin material dimensions.
Use this electrode to butter the
sides of oily cast iron to seal the
surface. Then finish the filling-up to
join the parts together with Unitor
NIFE-334N, which has greater tensile
strength. Do not deposit more than
maximum two layers for NICKEL-333N.
To be used on cast iron that takes In hot arc welding the part must first
strain, vibrations and sudden loads. be evenly heated to approximately
Also to be used for joining cast 500C. Especially if the casting to be
iron to steel, copper alloys and welded has any appreciable material
stainless steel. NIFE-334N is used thickness it is important that the
for multi-bead welding on heavy preheating proceeds slowly. Cast
gauge material. It has greater tensile iron has a low coefficient of thermal
strength than NICKEL-333N. conductivity, and demands care
in preheating. Too quick heating
can cause tension cracks. The
Electrode binding test temperature must be maintained
Grind off a small area of the material throughout the welding operation.
close to the welding zone. Select a As the means for preheating on board
3.2 mm electrode of NICKEL-333N and will normally be limited to the welding
NIFE-334N, and deposit a 4-5 cm bead torch, it means that only smaller parts,
with each of them without weaving. and which can be dismantled and
Use 100 Amps and the correct brought into the workshop can be hot
polarity. Use a hammer and chisel to welded on board.
remove the beads. The bead which When hot welding cast iron the
exhibits the least porosity on the temperature of the workpiece must be
87
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
88
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
89
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
90
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Wrong Correct
After the initial bead has been first bead with comfort. If you burn
deposited and peened, the next bead yourself, it is too hot to go on with the
should not be put down until the welding. Take your time, do not spoil
bare hand can be laid alongside the your work by trying to rush it.
91
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Sometimes more than one short spaced well away from each other to
run can be done at a time, but only prevent heat build-up. This technique
when the length to be welded is is called skip-welding and speeds up
considerable, and the beads can be the work considerably:
92
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
A way to reduse shrinkage stress cracks. Grind the edges of the casting
In order to reduce the shrinkage at an angel of 45 halfway down its
stresses, do not put down a complete wall thickness. Remember to file
root bead first, before proceeding to the ground area to remove surface
build up. "Stack" the beads stepwise graphite. Seal in the contaminants,
as shown in the sketch, advancing using Unitor NICKEL-334N. Using a
each bead (starting always with the piece of cardboard cut a template to
root bead) 2 - 3 cm forward at a time. obtain the correct shape for the steel
Take care to keep the heat down patch.
(hand warm before proceeding each Select a piece of low carbon steel,
new bead!) and hammer each bead one half the thickness of the casting's
while still hot. A small pneumatic wall. Using the template as a guide
hammer is suitable for this kind of cut the patch out of the piece of
hammering. steel. It should fit the hole with a
clearance of 2 - 3 mm. Grind the edge
2.07
of the patch 45. The patch should
Hammering
be "doomed" slightly by striking with
a ball-peen hammer until a bulge is
formed.
Place the patch in the hole and
secure it in position but do not
tackweld it. As this will prevent the
patch from expanding to heat. Now
Stacking weld the patch to the casting, using
the backstep technique as indicated
in the sketch. Be careful to let each
Steel insert technique bead of 2 - 3 cm cool off before
proceeding with the next bead. Use
It is sometimes desirable to insert a Unitor NIFE-334N for the build-up.
steel patch in the centre section of a
large housing or motor block. A gear Bevel edges to 45.
may have shattered and pushed out
an area in the housing. A frozen block steel-patch
may have suffered the same damage. Casting
Usually the pushed-out section has
been broken in so many pieces that
it is not practical to try to join the
pieces. The least expensive method or
repairs is to fit a steel patch into the
hole. This is done as follows:
Remove all damage material on the
casting. Avoid leaving sharp corners,
round off wherever possible. Clean
off dirt, paint, oil and grease from
the area where the repairs is to take
place. Use a Crack Detection kit
to make sure there are no hidden
93
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
94
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Braze welding of cast iron In braze welding the cast iron is heated
General to bonding temperature. This is the
The name braze welding comes from minimum temperature to which it must
the relatively slow-flowing nature of be heated to form a bound (surface
the filler material, which gives the alloy) between the filler metal and the
joining process much in common with cast iron. The phenomenon, which then
ordinary gas welding. occurs, is called "tinning" (also called
"wetting out" or "bonding"). Actually, it
A condition for using braze welding refers to the almost microscopically thin
on cast iron is that it must be possible layer in which the alloys of both the cast
to preheat an area on each side of the iron and the molten filler metal intermix.
weld zone to 300400C. In practice
this limits braze welding to smaller While there is several processes for braze
parts and thinner dimensions. For welding, the use of an oxy-acetylene torch
larger components "cold" electric arc to provide the necessary heat will be the
method employed on board.
welding is recommended. 2.07
In braze welding the cast iron is not
melted, and braze welding is thus Preparation of the workpiece
a form of mechanical bonding, as Remove oil, paint and rust from the
opposed to gas welding, where the surface. Grind off casting skin to a width
parent metal is melted and forms a of 20 mm on each side of the edges to be
chemical bonding with the filler metal. welded. If the damage is in the form of a
The use of braze welding on cast crack in the material, it is recommended
iron has the decided advantages to use the crack detector set to find
of low heat and ductility, both of the complete extent of the crack. Drill 3
which reduce and/or eliminate the mm holes at each end of the crack, at a
two serious problems traditionally distance of about 3 mm from the ends to
associated with welding cast iron. prevent the crack from opening further
during brazing.
These are:
I. The tendency for high heat to form Groove preparation
unwanted white cast iron, a form
of martensitic cast iron that is very Prepare a 7090 groove. Remember
brittle and hard due to the presence that braze welding is a surface bonding,
of iron carbide. The low heat used and that the lager the surface of a joint
in braze welding greatly reduces the better the bonding. If the part has
the possibility of this formation. been broken into two or more pieces,
bevel each side of the fracture to 45.
II. The problem of contraction during Use a file to remove surface graphite
cooling. These are avoided partly from the groove, and round off edges
due to the lower heat required, and sharp corners.
and partly because the brazing
filler alloy has a great capacity
to yield and accommodate any
cooling stresses. By braze welding
cast iron one is to a certain degree
independent of the quality of the
base material.
95
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
2.07 Preheating
After the searing is completed,
preheat the part(s) to 300 - 400 C with
a wide spread of heat to each side.
Remember that cast iron is one of
the more brittle and crack-sensitive
base metals. Thus care should be
exercised in the preheating to ensure
Braze leftward
that it is even and uniform.
96
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Cold repair of cast iron NB. In order for curing to take place
General the ambient temperature for polymers
Where there are limitations to hot must at least be + 5C. Polymer
work, cold repair materials are an products are organic material that will
alternative. Polymer materials are start to carbonise at 150C.This will
essentially epoxy or polyurethane make a natural limitation to polymer
products with additions of metal or when it comes to high temperature
ceramic filler. They are cold curing application and in cases where there
materials consisting of a base and are specific demand for fire retardant
activator that are mixed together. properties. One must also check
During solidification and curing it that the polymer product to be used
does not develop any heat. Polymer is resistant to the cargo the part is
materials form a surface bonding and handling.
it is absolutely essential that the base Recommended products:
materials surface be cleaned in order
Metalgrade Express 2.07
to give good addition.
Metalgrade Rebuild
Therefore: Leak Stop Pipe repair I, II or III
1) Surfaces must be cleaned and
ruffed up in order to give a good
bonding.
2) Measure out base and activator
according to instructions
3) Mix base and activator thoroughly
together. Any unmixed material will
not solidify.
4) At first only apply a small amount
of product and make sure to press
it hard into the prepared surface
securing good bonding. Afterwards
add more product and build up
to required height. If needed, a
reinforcement bandage can be
added to the product in order to
increase strength.
97
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Repair case 1.
In some repair situations the cast
iron is so corroded and oxidized that
welding is cannot be done In this kind
of situations cold repairs might be the
solution.
Clean surface to remove grease and
accumulated dirt. Remove as much of
the loose metal and oxides as possible.
Thoroughly abrade the edge and the
surrounding surface of the hole.
If the hole is large, a metal mesh
formed to the shape of the hole should
be made. Measure up and mix a small
2.07 quantity of Metalgrade Express and
apply it along the edge of the hole.
Remember to squeeze the product
hard into the surface to secure good
bonding. The first thin covering acts as
a "wetting layer" to improve adhesion.
Place the pre cut mesh down in the
hole so that it makes contact with the
polymer along the edge. If needed
secure it with additional polymer.
98
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Repair case 2.
After welding has successfully
been employed to weld a crack, it
sometimes turns out that there is
liquid penetrating through porosity in
the weld or heat affected zone.
99
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Thoroughly abrade the inside and Wrap reinforcement tape around the
outside of the plate to achieve a pipe and patch totally encapsulating
coarse profile. it. Make sure the product is
Measure up, mix and apply impregnating the tape so that the final
Metalgrade Rebuild or Express to surface consists of product that can
the prepared pipe surface and to the be smoothed out and blending in with
the pipe surface.
100
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
Repair case 4.
Polymer cold repair can also be
used with good results on cast iron
that requires large surface area
repairs. Welding will in most cases
crack the cast iron because of high
heat input, wile polymer being a
cold curing process has none of
these problems. Flange repairs are
a typical application area and so
are cast iron pump housings where
cavitational wear gouges out the
metal. When fluid flow environment
is creating wear, the correct product
to use is Ceramigrade Rebuild and/
2.07
or Liner (information on this products
to be found in the Unitor Welding
Handbook).
101
SOLUTIONS:Cast Iron
NICKEL-
333N
NICKEL-
333N
102
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.07
103
SOLUTIONS:Copper and Copper Alloys
Introduction
The most common type of copper is the oxide can cause porosity in the
electrolytically refined and treated to weld. Copper which is heated up to
obtain different qualities. Pure copper approx. 900C will become brittle and
has limited use on board except as weak as the copper oxide diffuses
copper piping. Cast parts are usually to the crystal boundaries where it
in brass or bronze alloy. collects and weakens the strength of
Copper normally contains a small the metal, in hot and cold condition.
amount of oxygen. Oxygen combines In this way, welding will weaken the
with the copper forming copper oxide. metal in a joint. The best method of
The oxide is distributed in the metal joining copper piping is therefore
in very small quantities and does not brazing with FC-BRONZE or with AG
affect the mechanical characteristics 45 or AG 60.
of the metal. However, during welding
Brass Bronze
Straight Special
brasses brasses
Brass
Brass is usually an alloy of copper Different types of special brasses are
and zinc, but other alloy elements also available:
may also be present. The zinc content
e.g. Admiralty brass (Cu 70%, Zn 29%,
in brass may vary from 550% in the
Sn 1%) or Naval brass (Cu 5864%,
different types.
Sn 1%, Zn balance). Both these may
The type of straight brasses used be brazed the same way as straight
for mechanical purposes will usually brasses. Aluminium brass however
contain between 6375% copper, i.e.: should be treated in a special way.
Cu 70%, Zn 30% (70:30 brass)
Cu 60%, Zn 40% (Muntz metal)
Brazing: AG 45 or AG 60 with
AG 60/45 FLUX
FC-BRONZE and
BRONZE FLUX
FC-WEARBRO and
WEARBRO FLUX
104
SOLUTIONS:Copper and Copper Alloys
The use of Yorcalbro piping allows Pipes with diameters less than 4''
a higher flow rate in the pipe than where the repair can take the form
possible with copper piping. A flow of an overlapped joint should be
rate up to 3.5m/s is permitted in silver brazed using Unitor AG 60
Yorcalbro pipes compared to 1.52 m/s and Unitor ALBRO flux.
in copper pipes. Pipes with diameters exceeding 4''
Aluminium brass pipes are more should be TIG welded using Unitor
durable than copper pipes. Aluminium IALBRO-237MF and the special flux,
brass pipes have a widespread IFLUX-238PF.
use in cooling water installations, Wire welding: IALBRO-W-237.
sanitary installations, oil coolers, heat
exchangers, heat coils etc. Pipes should be unstressed before
welding takes place, and cold
In view of the widespread use of bended piping should be annealed
aluminium brass piping on ships, at 400500C for approximately
maintenance is inevitable. Common 2030 min. Finished welds, and an
repairs include welding of leakages area covering approx. 15 cm to
and replacement of pipe lengths either side of the bead should be
subjected to corrosion. The most annealed. Annealing temperature
serious problems appear to arise 300400C for 3040 min.
in connection with the repair of
leakages in large-dimension Yorcalbro
pipes.
105
SOLUTIONS:Copper and Copper Alloys
Bronze
106
SOLUTIONS:Copper and Copper Alloys
CUNIFER 10 CUNIFER 30
(Copper nickel) (Cupro nickel)
Hardness HB
Hard (untreated) 155184 165204
Heat treated 97126
Annealed 78 97 87107
These alloys which have special mended. The use of 70/30 piping was
properties and are widely used on previously limited due to high cost.
vessels in river and canal traffic, on However, the recommendation for
lakes, or on vessels which regularly the use of these pipes over the entire
call at ports where the water is dimension range is based on the fact
heavily polluted or contains, sand that 70/30 pipes have a considerably
or sludge. They have excellent higher resistance to pitting corrosion
resistance against wear by erosion, than 90/10 pipes. Thermal power plants
corrosion and abrasion. all over the world use 70/30 pipes to
handle polluted cooling water. The
When it is envisaged that the piping same recommendation applies to
in a cooling system will be exposed to vessels which are regularly subjected
sulphide polluted seawater, material to polluted water in cooling systems.
with good resistance against water of
this type should be chosen. Industrial Brazing: AG60 and AG60/45 FLUX.
discharge may contain sulphides, TIG welding: ICUNI 30-239.
and even during a short stay in a Wire welding: ICUNI-W-239.
107
SOLUTIONS:Copper and Copper Alloys
BRONZ-ALLOY
Building up blade
of pump impeller
or walls in pump
housing. TINBRO-341
Repair of cracks in
large pump housings,
or rebuilding wear.
TINBRO-341
108
SOLUTIONS:Copper and Copper Alloys
TINBRO-341
Building up worn
threads or surfaces FC-BRONZE- 2.08
in valve and pump 261
components.
BRONZE-264
Rebuilding worn
sliding surfaces on
bronze bearings. FC-
WEARBRO-262
Yorcalbro-pipe
diameter less than
100 mm, where a
capillary joint can AG-60-252
be made, for joining
or for patching over
pittings.
Yolcalbro pipe
diameter over 100
mm, for patching or IALBRO-237MF
for joining.
IALBRO-W-237
109
SOLUTIONS:Copper and Copper Alloys
Joining Cunifer
2.08 pipes with diameter
under 100 mm, where
capillary joint can be
AG-60-252
prepared.
Large components
in Cunifer, like heat
exchangers. ICUNI-30-239
ICUNI-W-239
Conductors and
cables of copper.
SOLDERING
TIN-241 AG
110
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.08
111
SOLUTIONS: Aluminium
112
SOLUTIONS: Aluminium
ALUMIN-351
Cracks in larger 2.09
parts. ALUMAG-
W-235
ALUMAG-235
Holes or fractures in and
ALUFLUX-234F
smaller parts.
ALUMIN-351N
113
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
Poor fusion
Embedded slag
Pores
Root fault
114
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
115
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
The cracks might occur long time Tension cannot be avoided when
after welding is completed and are welding, as steel expands when
therefor often referred to as cold heated, although correct planning and
cracks. heat treatment can reduce tension
Other hydrogen sources are rust, considerably.
oil, paint or condensation along Slag embedded in weld
the welding groove. Preheating
the groove to say 50 C will help Slag consists of non-metallic particles
considerably in reducing the amount originating from the coating of the
of hydrogen. electrode. All slag must be properly
removed after finishing each weld
Conclusion: Dry basic electrodes bead. Use a chipping hammer and
when there is risk of cold cracking. wire brush for this purpose. Slag
embedded in the weld will seriously
Note the following: affect the strength of the weld. Try
Hard phases form when the weld to avoid burning cavities, as any slag
is cooled rapidly from melting deposited in such cavities will be
temperature to room rature. Alloying difficult to remove.
elements, mostly carbon, are forced
to dissolve in the weld metal and When preparing the welding groove,
make it brittle. The following formula make sure there is sufficient gap to
provide good fusion and easy slag
2.10 describes this process in the case of
standard carbon-manganese steel. removal. Clean off mill scale and rust
from the surfaces to be welded and
Ec = %C + %Mn + %(Cr+Mo+V) + %(Ni+Cu) make sure you choose the correct
6 5 15 electrode for the welding position to
Steels with Ec = 0.35 and below be used.
are usually weldable without any
problems at normal steel thickness.
For the more highly alloyed steels
and steels with thicker dimensions,
an elevated working temperature
is necessary in order to reduce the
cooling rate.
The elevated temperature also allows
the hydrogen to diffuse.
To determine elevated working
temperatures, please consult BS
5135:1984 or SS 064025. If the Ec
dimension of the plates and heat input
are known, these standards will state
whether heating is necessary and the
level at which it should take place.
116
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.10
117
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
118
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
Remember:
50% of quality is edge preparation
119
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
The root pass in multi pass grooves are Groove welds are prone to undercut along
especially susceptible to cracking the edges, increasing the risk of trapping
slag when the next pass is made
120
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
After welding
Visual inspection after welding has
been completed is also useful in
evaluating quality, even if ultrasonic,
radiographic, or other methods
are to be employed. As welding
progresses, surface flaws such as
cracks, porosity, and unfilled craters
can be detected, leading to repairs
or rejection of the work. There is no
point in submitting an obvious bad Underwelding is a violation of specification
and can not be tolerated.
weld to sophisticated inspection
methods.
Dimensional variations from
tolerances, warping, and faults in
appearance are detected visually at
this stage. The extent and continuity
of the weld, its size, and the length of
segments in intermittent welds can be
readily measured or recorded.
Welds must be cleaned from slag to Overwelding is costly and serves no useful
2.10
make inspection for surface flaws purpose. It only makes the construction
possible. A 10x magnifying glass is stiffer and heavier.
helpful in detecting fine cracks and
other faults. Shot blasting should not
be used prior to examination, since
the peening action may seal fine
cracks and make them invisible. A-measurement
The objective of visual inspection at Leg length
this stage is not only to detect non
permissible faults, but also to give
clues as to what may be wrong in the
entire repair /fabrication process. If
the inspector has a sound knowledge
of welding, he can read much from Leg length
what he sees. Thus, the presence of
excessive porosity and slag inclusions
may be an indication of insufficient
current even if the dial readings
on the machine tell otherwise.
Subsequent tests will also give clues The designer has specified a weld
to faults in equipment or procedures, size and this should be observed.
but the information acquired through For filled joints it is also important
visual examination allows corrections that the leg lengths are equal.
to be made before results from more
sophisticated methods become
available.
121
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
Underfill Undercut
Too high welding speed High current,
Insufficient electrode angle.
Speed of travel too fast.
122
SOLUTIONS: Evaluation of welds
Step 1) Step 2)
Remove surface rust, scale, paint by Spray penetrant over the area and allow
mechanical means, spray cleaner to to soak for about ten minutes.
degrease the inspection area. Leave to dry. 2.10
Step 3) Step 4)
Remove all excess penetrant using a dry Spray developer evenly over the inspec-
cloth and wipe dry. tion area and wait a few minutes until the
area dries white. Any surface defects will
appear in red contrast.
123
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
2.10
124
CONSUMABLES
3.01
125
COATED ELECTRODES
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Types of electrodes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Storing and re-drying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Classification and approvals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Welding positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
GPO-302 N General Purpose Electrode For Mild Steel . . . . . . 150
GPR-300H High Recovery Electrode for Mild Steel . . . . . . . . 152
SPECIAL-303 N Double Coated Electrode for Mild
and Ship Quality Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
LH-314 N Low Hydrogen Electrode for Ship Quality Steel . . 156
LHH-314 H High Recovery Low Hydrogen Electrode
for Ship Quality Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
LHV-316 N Vertical Down Welding Low Hydrogen
Electrode for Ship Quality Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
LHT-318 N Electrode for High Temperature Steel . . . . . . . . . . 162
LHL-319 N Electrode for Low Temperature Steel . . . . . . . . . . 164
3.01 LHR-320 N Electrode for Weathering Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
TENSILE-328 N Electrode for Difficult-to-Weld Steel . . . . . . . . . . . 168
IMPACT-329 S Electrode for Heat Resistant Overlays . . . . . . . . . . 170
WEARMAX-327 Electrode for Joining & Wear Resistant Overlays 172
ABRATECH-330 Electrode for abrasive wear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
18/8-321 N Electrode for Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
23/14-322 N Electrode for Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
DUPLEX-325 N Electrode for Duplex Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
PICKLING GEL Pickling Gel for Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
126
COATED ELECTRODES
127
COATED ELECTRODES
128
COATED ELECTRODES
3.01
The coated electrode
Rod core grip end
Coating
Electrode size
Rod core
129
COATED ELECTRODES
130
COATED ELECTRODES
131
COATED ELECTRODES
other electrodes, which can be used coating extruded onto the core rod
in this position. This results in a small- followed by a thicker basic
er number of electrode changes. The layer. In this way the
normal result is therefore a higher electrode gets the fine
fusion rate and higher arc-time fac- droplet transfer of rutile
tor when welding vertically upwards electrodes and the
with basic electrodes compared with deposit strength of
other types. The slag is normally not the basic electrode.
quite as easy to remove as the slag
from acid or rutile electrodes, but,
in spite of this, it can be classed as
easily detachable. The slag from
basic electrodes has a lower melt-
ing point than that from rutile or acid
electrodes. The risk of slag inclusions
during normal production welding is
therefore unusually small when basic
electrodes are used, even if the slag
is not completely removed between
beads during multi-run welding.
The weld metal from basic electrodes
has a low hydrogen content and
3.01 usually has good toughness even at
low temperatures. Basic electrodes
are less likely to produce either hot
cracks or cold cracks compared
with other types of electrode. The
superiority of basic electrodes from
this point of view appears when
welding manganese-alloyed structural
steels, pressure-vessel steels and
ships plate with a nominal tensile
strength of 490-530 MPa. The
higher the hardenability of the
steel to be welded, the greater
the necessity to use basic
electrodes and the greater the
need for low moisture content
in the coating.
Double coated electrodes
These electrodes consist
of a thin layer of rutile Core rod
Basic coating
Rutile coating
132
COATED ELECTRODES
133
COATED ELECTRODES
134
COATED ELECTRODES
Heating
Cabinet
at 80 C
3.01
All basic electrodes and
stainless steel electrodes Rutile electrodes
should be re-dried before normally no need for
use. Always do when re-drying.
there is application
requirements.
Minidryer
300350 C Observe recommended
re-drying temperatures
and holding times for
Unitor electrodes stated
on box label
Unused electrodes
should be re-dried
before being returned Max exposure
to the heating cabinet. time for electrodes
in the open is 8
hours.
Worksite
135
COATED ELECTRODES
Type Mains Heater Primary Operating Width x Depth x Height Electrode Net
Voltage Output Current Temperature Inner Dimensions Outer Dimensions Capacity Weight
V W A C mm mm kg kg
Mini- 230, 400 1.8 100 to 350 100 x 460 170 x 170 x 570 8 7
dryer- 50/60 Hz
350
136
COATED ELECTRODES
137
COATED ELECTRODES
Type Mains Heater Primary Operating Width x Depth x Height Electrode Net
Voltage Output Current Temperature Inner Dimensions Outer Dimensions Capacity Weight
V W A C mm mm kg kg
Heating 230,
500 1,3 30-85 460 x 520 x 860 564 x 640 x 1095 350 70
Cabinet- 50/60 Hz
85
138
COATED ELECTRODES
139
COATED ELECTRODES
EN 499 Covered electrodes for manual arc welding of non alloy and fine grain steel DIN 1913
BS 639
NEN 2560
DIN 8529
EN 757 Covered electrodes for manual metal arc welding of high strength steel DIN 8556
BS 2926
EN 1600 Covered electrodes for manual metal arc welding of stainless and heat resisting steel NEN 3581
DIN 8575
BS 2493
EN 1599 Covered electrodes for manual metal arc welding of creep-resisting steel NEN 3580
140
COATED ELECTRODES
Guide to Approvals
This page shows the grading which Approvals may be carried out by the
the electrode has under its relevant following classifications societies:
classification society approvals. American Bureau of Shipping (ABS)
The full grading code consists of a Bureau Veritas (BV)
digit and one or more letters. The Det Norske Veritas (DNV)
digit indicates the tensil and notch Germanisher Lloyd (GL)
toughness grade (see table). Letters Lloyds Register of Shipping (LR)
indicate higher tensile steels.
Lettering Code:
Y = approved for higher tensile steels.
Note: ABS deviates slightly on yield and tensile strength limits for grades 2Y
and 3Y and also on impact test values in all grades.
141
COATED ELECTRODES
Guide to EN 499-1995
Tensile Yield Elongation Symbol Welding position
Symbol strength strength min. %
MPa MPa 1 All positions.
35 440570 355 22 2 All positions, except vertical down.
38 470600 380 20 3 Flat butt weld, flat fillet weld,
horizontal-vertical fillet weld.
42 500640 420 20
4 Flat butt weld, flat fillet weld.
46 530680 460 20
5 Vertical down and positions
50 560720 500 18 according to symbol 3.
1 <105 AC + DC
2 <105 DC
3 >105125 AC + DC
4 >105125 DC
5 >125160 AC + DC
6 >125160 DC
7 >160 AC + DC
8 >160 DC
E 46 6 2Ni B 3 2 H5
3.01
Covered electrode for Symbol Coating type Hydrogen ml/100 g
manual metal-arc welding. Symbol deposited
A Acid weld metal, max.
B Basic H5 5
Impact energy C Cellulosic H10 10
Symbol Charpy-V R Rutile
Temp C for H15 15
47J min. RR Rutile (thick coated)
RC Rutile-Cellulosic
Z No requirements
RA Rutile-Acid
A +20
RB Rutile-Basic
0 0
2 20
3 30
Chemical composition*
4 40 Symbol
5 50 Mn Mo Ni
6 60 No symbol 2.0
Mo 1.4 0.30.6
MnMo >1.42.0 0.30.6
1 Ni 1.4 0.61.2
2 Ni 1.4 1.82.6
3 Ni 1.4 >2.63.8
Mn 1 Ni >1.42.0 0.61.2
1 NiMo 1.4 0.30.6 0.61.2
Z Any other composition
* If not specified Mo <0.2, Ni <0.3, Cr <0.2, V <0.05,
Nb <0.05, Cu <0.3.
Single values shown in the table mean maximum values.
142
COATED ELECTRODES
Guide to EN 757-1997
Symbol Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation Symbol Welding positions
min. MPa MPa min. %
1 All positions
55 550 610-780 18 2 All positions, except vertical down
62 620 690-890 18 3 Flat butt weld, flat fillet weld,
69 690 760-960 17 horizontal-vertical fillet weld.
79 790 880-1080 16 4 Flat butt weld, flat fillet weld.
89 890 980-1180 15 5 Vertical down and positions
according to symbol 3.
1 105 AC+DC
2 105 DC
3 >105 125 AC+DC
4 >105 125 DC
5 >125 160 AC+DC
6 >125 160 DC Indicates mechanical
7 >160 AC+DC properties after stress
8 >160 DC relief treatment.
E 62 7 MnNI B 3 4 H5 T
3.01
143
COATED ELECTRODES
Guide to EN 1600-1977
Covered electrode/ Type of electrode covering: Symbol Metal recovery, % Type of current
manual metal arc R= rutile covering
welding. B= basic covering 1 105 AC+DC
2 105 DC
3 >105 125 AC+DC
4 >105 125 DC
5 >125 160 AC+DC
E 23 12 2L R 3 2
6
7
>125 160
>160
DC
AC+DC
8 >160 DC
Alloy Chemical composition of all-weld metal, %*
Symbol C Si Mn P S Cr Ni Mo Other elements
Martensitic/ferritic
13 0.12 1.0 1.5 0.030 0.025 11.0-14.0 - - -
13 4 0.06 1.0 1.5 0.030 0.025 11.0-14.5 3.0-5.0 0.4-1.0 -
17 0.12 1.0 1.5 0.030 0.025 16.0-18.0 - - -
3.01 Austenitic
19 9 0.08 1.2 2.0 0.030 0.025 18.0-21.0 9.0-11.0 - -
19 9L 0.04 1.2 2.0 0.030 0.025 18.0-21.0 9.0-11.0 - -
19 9 Nb 0.08 1.2 2.0 0.030 0.025 18.0-21.0 9.0-11.0 - Nb
19 12 2 0.08 1.2 2.0 0.030 0.025 17.0-20.0 10.0-13.0 2.0-3.0 -
19 12 3 L 0.04 1.2 2.0 0.030 0.025 17.0-20.0 10.0-13.0 2.5-3.0 -
19 12 3 Nb 0.08 1.2 2.0 0.030 0.025 17.0-20.0 10.0-13.0 2.5-3.0 Nb
19 13 4 N L 0.04 1.2 1.0-5.0 0.030 0.025 17.0-20.0 12.0-15.0 3.0-4.5 N 0.20
Austenitic-ferritic. High corrosion resistance
22 9 3 N L 0.04 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 21.0-24.0 7.5-10.5 2.5-4.0 N 0.08-0.20
25 7 2 N L 0.04 1.2 2.0 0.035 0.025 24.0-28.0 6.0-8.0 1.0-3.0 N 0.20
25 9 3 Cu N L 0.04 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 24.0-27.0 7.5-10.5 2.5-4.0 N 0.10-0.25, Cu 1.5-3.5
25 9 4 N L 0.04 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 24.0-27.0 8.0-10.5 2.5-4.5 N 0.20-0.30, Cu 1.5, W 1.0
Fully austenitic. High corrosion resistance
18 15 3 L 0.04 1.2 1.0-4.0 0.030 0.025 16.5-19.5 14.0-17.0 2.5-3.5 -
18 16 5 N L 0.04 1.2 1.0-4.0 0.035 0.025 17.0-20.0 15.5-19.0 3.0-5.0 N 0.20
20 25 5 Cu N L 0.04 1.2 1.0-4.0 0.030 0.025 19.0-22.0 24.0-27.0 4.0-7.0 Cu 1.0-2.0, N 0.25
20 16 3 Mn N L 0.04 1.2 5.0-8.0 0.035 0.025 18.0-21.0 15.0-18.0 2.5-3.5 N 0.20
25 22 2 N L 0.04 1.2 1.0-5.0 0.030 0.025 24.0-27.0 20.0-23.0 2.0-3.0 N 0.20
27 31 4 Cu L 0.04 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 26.0-29.0 30.0-33.0 3.0-4.5 Cu 0.6-1.5
Special types
18 8 Mn 0.20 1.2 4.5-7.5 0.035 0.025 17.0-20.0 7.0-10.0 - -
18 9 Mn Mo 0.04-0.14 1.2 3.0-5.0 0.035 0.025 18.0-21.5 9.0-11.0 0.5-1.5 -
20 10 3 0.10 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 18.0-21.0 9.0-12.0 1.5-3.5 -
23 12 L 0.04 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 22.0-25.0 11.0-14.0 - -
23 12 Nb 0.10 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 22.0-25.0 11.0-14.0 - Nb
23 12 2 L 0.04 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 22.0-25.0 11.0-14.0 2.0-3.0 -
29 9 0.15 1.2 2.5 0.035 0.025 27.0-31.0 8.0-12.0 - -
Heat resisting types
16 8 2 0.08 1.0 2.5 0.030 0.025 14.5-16.5 7.5-9.5 1.5-2.5 -
19 9 H 0.04-0.08 1.2 2.0 0.030 0.025 18.0-21.0 9.0-11.0 - -
25 4 0.15 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 24.0-27.0 4.0-6.0 - -
22 12 0.15 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 20.0-23.0 10.0-13.0 - -
25 20 0.06-0.20 1.2 1.0-5.0 0.030 0.025 23.0-27.0 18.0-22.0 - -
25 20 H 0.35-0.45 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 23.0-27.0 18.0-22.0 - -
18 36 0.25 1.2 2.5 0.030 0.025 14.0-18.0 33.0-37.0 - -
* Single values shown in the table are maximum values.
144
COATED ELECTRODES
E 70 18 M
E 70 16 1 HZ R
3.01
AWS Tensile Yield strength min. Impact Type of Current
Classifi- Strength min. Elongation
Welding Type of coating
min % Energy Position
cation ksi MPa ksi MPa Charp-V J/C AC DC
145
COATED ELECTRODES
Guide to AWSA5.5-1996
Covered Designates AWS Welding Type of current
electrode welding Type of coating
for manual position, Classification Position AC DC
metal-arc coating type
welding and current E xx 10 1 Cellulosic + pol
type. E xx 11 1 Cellulosic x + pol
E xx 12 1 Rutile x pol
E xx 13 1 Rutile x +/ pol
E xx 15 1 Basic + pol
E xx 16 1 Basic x + pol
E xx 18 1 Basic, iron powder x + pol
E 80 18 C1 E xx 20 2 Acid x c) +/ pol
E xx 27 2 Acid, high recovery x c) +/ pol
AWS Tensile strength Yield strength Code Welding position
classification min./MPa min./MPa
1 All positions except vertical-down
E 70 xx-x 480 390 2 Flat and H-V fillets
3.01 E 80 xx-x 550 460
E 80 xx-C3 550 470550
E 90 xx-x 620 530
E 90 xx-M 620 540620
E 100 xx-x 690 600
E 100 xx-M 690 610690 AWS Impact energy
E 110 xx-x 760 670 classification min. J C
E 110 xx-M 760 680760
E 120 xx-x 830 740 E 8018-NM 27 40
E 120 xx-M 830 745830 E 8016-C3 27 40
E 120 xx-M1 830 745830 E 8018-C3 27 40
E 8016-D3 27 51
E 8018-D3 27 51
E 9015-D1 27 51
E 9018-D1 27 51
Suffix Alloying system Nominal values Wt% E 10015-D2 27 51
E 10016-D2 27 51
A1 C/Mo ~0.1/0.5 E 10018-D2 27 51
B1 Cr/Mo ~0.5/0.5 E 9018-M 27 51
B2 Cr/Mo ~1.3/0.5 E 10018-M 27 51
B2L* Cr/Mo ~1.3/0.5 E 11018-M 27 51
B3 Cr/Mo ~2.3/1.0 E 12018-M 27 51
B3L* Cr/Mo ~2.3/1.0 E 12018-M1 68 18
B4L* Cr/Mo ~2.0/0.5 E 7018-W 27 18
B5 Cr/Mo/V ~0.5/1.0/0.05 E 8018-W 27 18
C1 Ni ~2.5 E 8016-C1 27 59
C1L* Ni ~2.5 E 8018-C1 27 59
C2 Ni ~3.5 E 7015-C1L 27 73
C2L* Ni ~3.5 E 7016-C1L 27 73
C3 Ni/Cr/Mo/V ~1.0/0.1/0.3/0.05 E 7018-C1L 27 73
NM Ni/Mo ~1.0/0.5 E 8016-C2 27 73
D1 Mn/Mo ~1.5/0.3 E 8018-C2 27 73
D2 Mn/Mo ~1.8/0.3 E 7015-C2L 27 101
D3 Mn/Mo ~1.5/0.5 E 7016-C2L 27 101
G/M/W All other alloy steel electrodes E 7018-C2L 27 101
All other Not required
* C max. 0.05%.
146
COATED ELECTRODES
classification C Cr Ni Mo Nb + Ta Mn Si P S N Cu
E 209 -xx 0.06 20.524.0 9.512.0 1.53.0 4.07.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.100.30 0.75
E 219-xx 0.06 19.021.5 5.57.0 0.75 8.010.0 1.0 0.04 0.03 0.100.30 0.75
E 240-xx 0.06 17.019.0 4.06.0 0.75 10.513.5 1.0 0.04 0.03 0.100.30 0.75
E 307-xxx 0.040.14 18.021.5 9.010.7 0.51.5 3.304.75 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 308-xx 0.08 18.021.0 9.011.0 0.75 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 308 H-xx 0.040.08 18.021.0 9.011.0 0.75 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 308 L-xx 0.04 18.021.0 9.011.0 0.75 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 308 Mo-xx 0.08 18.021.0 9.012.0 2.03.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75 3.01
E 308 MoL-xx 0.04 18.021.0 9.012.0 2.03.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 309-xx 0.15 22.025.0 12.014.0 0.75 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 309 L-xx 0.04 22.025.0 12.014.0 0.75 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 309 Cb-xx 0.12 22.025.0 12.014.0 0.75 0.701.00 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 309 Mo-xx 0.12 22.025.0 12.014.0 2.03.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 309 MoL-xx 0.04 22.025.0 12.014.0 2.03.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 310-xx 0.080.20 25.028.0 20.022.5 0.75 1.02.5 0.75 0.03 0.03 0.75
E 310 H-xx 0.350.45 25.028.0 20.022.5 0.75 1.02.5 0.75 0.03 0.03 0.75
E 310 Cb-xx 0.12 25.028.0 20.022.0 0.75 0.701.00 1.02.5 0.75 0.03 0.03 0.75
E 310 Mo-xx 0.12 25.028.0 20.022.0 2.03.0 1.02.5 0.75 0.03 0.03 0.75
E 312-xx 0.15 28.032.0 8.010.5 0.75 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 316-xx 0.08 17.020.0 11.014.0 2.03.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 316 H-xx 0.040.08 17.020.0 11.014.0 2.03.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 316 L-xx 0.04 17.020.0 11.014.0 2.03.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 317-xx 0.08 18.021.0 12.014.0 3.04.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 317 L-xx 0.04 18.021.0 12.014.0 3.04.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 318-xx 0.08 17.020.0 11.014.0 2.03.0 6xC1.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 320-xx 0.07 19.021.0 32.036.0 2.03.0 8xC1.0 0.52.5 0.60 0.04 0.03 3.04.0
E 320 LR-xx 0.03 19.021.0 32.036.0 2.03.0 8xC0.40 1.52.5 0.30 0.02 0.015 3.04.0
E 330-xx 0.180.25 14.017.0 33.037.0 0.75 1.02.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 330 H-xx 0.350.45 14.017.0 33.037.0 0.75 1.02.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 347-xx 0.08 18.021.0 9.011.0 0.75 8xC1.0 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 349-xx 0.13 18.021.0 8.010.0 0.350.65 0.751.20 0.52.5 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 383-xx 0.03 26.529.0 30.033.0 3.24.2 0.52.5 0.90 0.02 0.02 0.61.5
E 385-xx 0.03 19.521.5 24.026.0 4.25.2 1.02.5 0.75 0.03 0.02 1.22.0
E 410-xx 0.12 11.013.5 0.7 0.75 1.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 410 NiMo-xx 0.06 11.012.5 4.05.0 0.400.70 1.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 430-xx 0.10 15.018.0 0.6 0.75 1.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 502-xx 0.10 4.06.0 0.4 0.450.65 1.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 505-xx 0.10 8.010.5 0.4 0.851.20 1.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 630-xx 0.05 16.016.75 4.55.0 0.75 0.150.30 0.250.75 0.75 0.04 0.03 3.254.00
E 16-8-2-xx 0.10 14.516.5 7.59.5 1.02.0 0.52.5 0.60 0.03 0.03 0.75
E 7 Cr-xx 0.10 6.08.0 0.4 0.450.65 1.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.75
E 2209-xx 0.04 21.523.5 8.510.5 2.53.5 0.52.0 0.90 0.04 0.03 0.080.20 0.75
E 2553-xx 0.06 25.027.0 6.58.5 2.93.9 0.51.5 1.0 0.04 0.03 0.100.25 1.52.5
147
COATED ELECTRODES
Welding positions
3.01
PF PG
AWS: 3G AWS: 3F AWS: 5G AWS: 5F
EN: PG (down) EN: PG (down) EN: PG (down) EN: PG (down)
PF (up) PF (up) PF (up) PF (up)
148
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.01
149
GPO-302 N
Imprint
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.1 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 6013 E 38 O RC 11
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
2 2 2 2 2
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+/-
PA PB PC PF PG PE, PD
Materials General structural steel DIN 17100 St33, St37-2 to St44-3
to be welded NF A35-501 A33, A34-2, E24-2 (4), E28-2 (3) E30-2 (3)
BS 4360 Gr. 40A-C, 43A-C
Ship plates Grade A, B, C, D
Cast steel DIN 1681 GS38
Pipe material DIN 17172 StE210.7, StE240.7, StE290.7, StE320.7, StE360.7
API 5 LX X42, X46
DIN 1626-1630 St37.0/4, St44.0/4
Boiler & pressure DIN 17155 HI, HII, 17Mn4
vessel steel NF A 36-205 A37 (CP), A42 (CP), A48 (CP)
3.01 NF A36-207 A510AP, A530AP, A550AP
BS 1501 151/154/161-Gr. 360/400, 164-Gr.360
Elevated temperature steel DIN 17175 St35.8, St45.8
Fine grained steel DIN 17102 StE255 to StE315
NF A36-203 E275D
510 400 29 At 0C = 70
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.5 60100 50 0.8 86 1
3.2 80150 57 1.3 53 2
4.0 100200 65 1.6 39 2
* SDS available on request.
** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 350 295 5.2 095-699165 3
3.2 350 190 5.4 095-699173 3
4.0 350 120 5.2 095-699181 3
150
GPO-302 N
151
GPR-300 H
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.1 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 7024 E 42 0 RR 73
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
2 2Y 2Y 2 2
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+/-
PA PB
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
3.2 130170 69 2.5 21.0 2
4.0 180230 69 3.8 13.5 2
5.0 250340 68 5.8 9.1 3
6.0 300430 72 7.5 6.6 4
* SDS available on request. ** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 450 85 5.8 095-699231 3
4.0 450 51 5.5 095-699249 3
5.0 450 35 5.6 095-699256 3
6.0 450 23 5.3 095-699260 3
Re-drying temperature: Normally no need.
152
GPR-300 H
153
SPECIAL-303 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.1 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 7016 E 38 2B 32 H10
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
Materials General structural steel DIN 17100 St33, St37-2 to St52-3
to be welded NF A35-501 A33, A34-2, E24-2 (4) to E36-2 (4)
BS 4360 Grade 43D, 50D
Ship plates Grade A, B, C, D, E, AH, DH, EH
Cast steel DIN 1681 GS38, GS45, GS52
BS3100 A1, A2, A3, AM1, AM2, AW1
Pipe material DIN 17172 StE210.7, StE240.7, StE290.7, StE320.7, StE360.7
API 5 LX X42, X46, X52, X60
DIN 1626-1630 St37.0/4, St44.0/4, ST52.0/4
3.01 Boiler & pressure DIN 17155 HI, HII, 17Mn4, 19Mn5
vessel steel NF A36-205 A37 (CP, AP), A42 (CP, AP), A48 (CP, AP), A52 (CP, AP)
NF A36-207 A510 AP, A530 AP, A550 AP
BS 1501 151/154/161-Gr. 360/400/430, 164-Gr. 360/400
Elevated temperature steel DIN 17175 St.35.8, St.45.8
Fine grained steel DIN 17102 St.E255 to St.E420
NF A 36-203 E275 D, E344D, E390D, E430D, E455D
Welding data Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.0 40-80 75 0.6 143 2
2.5 5090 54 0.9 77 2
3.2 90150 57 1.4 46 2
4.0 120190 79 1.9 24 3
* SDS available on request. ** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.0 350 115 1.7 095-699199 6
2.5 350 200 4.1 095-699207 3
3.2 350 120 4.1 095-699215 3
4.0 450 75 5.2 095-699223 3
Re-drying temperature: 300 C (572 F) for two hours.
154
SPECIAL-303 N
Root edge
Molten pool
3.01
Excellent in difficult position welding Welding mild and ship quality steel
155
LH-314 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.1 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 7018 E 42 4 B 42 H5
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.5 75105 58 1.0 62.5 2
3.2 95155 80 1.5 31.3 3
4 125210 85 2.1 20.5 3
* SDS available on request. ** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 350 161 4.0 095-699264 3
3.2 450 95 5.0 095-699272 3
4 450 78 5.6 095-699280 3
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
156
LH-314 N
157
LHH-314 H
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.1 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 7028 E 42 4 B 73 H5
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
4.0 170240 70 3.7 14.4 4
5.0 225355 72 5.7 9.6 4
* SDS available on request. ** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
4.0 450 54 5.5 095-699298 3
5.0 450 36 5.5 095-699306 3
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
158
LHH-314 H
159
LHV-316 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.5 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 8018-G E 46 4 B 41 H5
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
3.2 110150 53 1.6 43.7 2
4.0 180220 50 2.8 27.0 2
* SDS available on request.
** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 137 4.8 095-699314 3
4.0 350 99 5.0 095-699322 3
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
160
LHV-316 N
161
LHT-318 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.5 EN 1599
E 8018-B2 E CrMo 1B 42 H5
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
H 10 UP SR
Type of current
0.05 - 0.10 0.30 - 0.80 0.20 - 0.50 max. 0.015 max. 0.020 1.25 - 1.45 0.50 - 0.65
Typical mech. properties *
of weld metal Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.5 70105 60 0.8 73 3
3.2 95150 65 1.1 49 3
* SDS available on request.
** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 350 75 1.7 095-699330 6
3.2 350 48 1.7 095-699348 6
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
162
LHT-318 N
163
LHL-319 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.5 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 8018-C1 E 46 6 2 Ni B 32 H5
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
Can also be used for welding CorTen steel and Mayari R steels.
0.02 - 0.10 0.65 - 1.15 0.15 - 0.55 max. 0.020 max. 0.020 2.15 - 2.65
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 350 78 1.8 095-683631 6
3.2 350 48 1.8 095-683649 6
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
164
LHL-319 N
3.01
165
LHR-320 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.5 EN-ISO 2560-A
E 8018-G E 46 5 Z B 32
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
0.02 - 0.10 0.75 - 1.25 0.15 - 0.55 max. 0.020 0.50 - 0.90 0.30 - 0.50
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.5 80115 59 0.9 66 2
3.2 100150 70 1.3 40 2
* SDS available on request.
** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 350 88 1.7 095-683656 6
3.2 350 48 1.8 095-699389 6
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
166
LHR-320 N
LHR-320 N is a NiCu-alloyed
electrode,which deposits a weld
metal with good corrosion resistance
to sea-water and flue gases, for weld-
ing of weathering steel (Patinax steel,
Cor-Ten A steel, Mayari R steel) and
for ship hull construction steel.
The weld metal has excellent
mechanical properties. It is particular-
ly suitable for welding the shell plat-
ing of ice breakers and other ships,
which work under conditions where
the protective paint coating wears off.
Weathering steels are low-alloy steels
that can be exposed to the weather
without being painted. The steel pro-
tects itself by means of a dense oxide
coating (patina) which forms naturally
on the steel when it is exposed to the
weather.
This tight oxide coating reduces
continuing corrosion. The corrosion
resistance of weathering steels is four 3.01
to six times that of normal structural
carbon steels, and two to three times
that of many of the low-alloy struc- Flue gases corrosion
tural steels.
The weathering steels are covered by
the ASTM specification A242. These
steels have a minimum yield strength
of 350 Mpa (50,000 psi) with an ulti-
mate tensile strength of 490 Mpa
(70,000 psi).
To maintain the weather resistance
characteristic of the steel, it is impor-
tant to use an electrode with same
chemical composition.
167
TENSILE-328 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A 5.4 EN-ISO 3581-A EN 14 700
E 312-17 E 29 9 R 12 E Fe 11
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
0.08 - 0.15 0.50 - 1.00 0.50 - 0.90 28.0 - 30.0 9.0 - 10.5
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.5 5085 48 0.9 78 6
3.2 80125 65 1.3 42 7
* SDS available on request. ** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 300 79 1.6 096-699470 6
3.2 350 50 2.0 096-699488 6
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
168
TENSILE-328 N
169
IMPACT-329 S
Unitor IMPACT-329 S
Classifications
DIN 8555
E 20-UM-250-CRTZ
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time / Deposition rate Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal Danish Std.
3.2 70120 66 1.36 40 7
4 90150 100 1.33 27 7
* SDS available on request.
Packaging data
DDiameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 39 1.4 096-606460 6
4 350 27 1.4 096-606461 6
Re-drying temperature: 250 C (482 F) for one hour.
170
IMPACT-329 S
1. Machine preparation
Align the spindle in a lathe and turn a suitably wide and
deep groove in the hardened face to remove all stellite down
to clean, pure base material
Make room for at least two layers of weld metal.
2. Weld preparation
Suggested jig for holding
Welding should as far as possible be carried spindles.
out in the horizontal position. A suitable jig should
be prepared, holding the spindle in a tilted position allowing it to be rotated.
5. Cooling
When the top layer is completed, the spindle
should be immersed in insulating material or dry
sand in order to ensure slow cooling.
6. Final machining
After cooling, machine to correct tolerances, use
toolbit quality H1 or K10 with negative 4 cutting
angle, low turning speed and fine feeding. Ensure slow cooling.
171
WEARMAX-327
Unitor WEARMAX-327
Classifications
AWS A5.4
~ E 307-26
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
(2.5mm only)
Materials Repair of: Worn winch wheels and anchor windlass wheels on anchoring systems. Cargo
to be welded handling equipment and dredger equipment, T1-steel, N-A-Xtra steel, OXAR steel, Fine
grain steel, Cr Mo steel, Manganese steel, Shear blades.
Trawler equipment subject to metal to earth wear and metal to metal wear. Suitable for
both joining and making wear resistant overlays.
3.01
All weld metal composition
Fe Cr Ni Mo Mn Si
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time / Deposition rate Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal Danish Std.
2.5 75140 80 0.9 48 6
3.2 90170 103 1.2 31 6
4 120240 105 1.8 21 7
* SDS available on request.
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 350 49 1.6 095-606454 6
3.2 350 68 3.5 095-606455 3
4 350 42 3.4 095-606456 3
Re-drying temperature: 250 C (482 F) for one hour.
172
WEARMAX-327
Areas of application:
Anchor winch wheels and guides,
windlasses drums and rollers, cranes
and track wheels, sprocket wheels.
3.01
Also used for joining Cr Mo steel,
T1-steel, Manganese steel, N-A-Xtra
steel, OXAR steel, HARDOX 400, fine
grain steel and shear blades.
Special publication
ID.No. 11051
WEARMAX 327
Available
173
ABRATECH-330
Unitor ABRATECH-330
Classifications
DIN 8555
E 10-UM-60-G
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC
57-62 170
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time / Deposition rate Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal Danish Std.
3,2 100-150 95 1.34 28.3 6
* SDS available on request.
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 68 3.5 095-725275 3
Re-drying temperature: 250 C (482 F) for two hours.
174
ABRATECH-330
175
18/8-321 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A5.4 EN-ISO 3581-A
E 316L-17 E 19 12 3 LR 12
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
max. 0.030 0.5 - 1.2 max. 0.9 17.0 - 19.0 11.0 - 13.0 2.5 - 3.0 310
Typical mech. properties
of weld metal Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
1.6 3045 26 0.6 230 3
2.5 4590 35 1.1 97 4
3.2 60135 46 1.4 56 4
* SDS available on request. ** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
1.6 300 213 1.7 095-699397 6
2.5 300 89 1.7 095-699405 6
3.2 350 54 1.7 095-699413 6
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
176
18/8-321 N
177
23/14-322 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A5.4 EN-ISO 3581-A
E 309MoL-17 E 23 12 2 LR 32
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
Materials Steel grades BS 970 DIN 17440 W.Nr. AFNOR ASTM/ACI SIS UNS
to be welded First layer in 316S11 X2CrNiMo17132 1.4404 Z2CND17.12 (TP) 316L 2353 S31603
CrNiMo- CF-3M J92800
claddings 316S13 X2CrNiMo18143 1.4435
X2CrNiMoN17122 1.4406 Z2CND17.12 lN (TP) 316LN S31653
X2CrNiMoN17133 1.4429 Z2CND17.13 lN
316S31 X5CrNiMo17122 1.4401 Z6CND17.11 316 (TP) 316 (H) (2347) S31600/
316S33 X5CrNiMo17133 1.4436 Z6CND17.12 2343 S30409
3.01 320S31 X6CrNiMo17122 1.4571 Z6CNDT17.12 316Ti (2344) S31635/S32100
X10CrNiMoTi1812 1.4573 Z6CNDT 17.12 316Ti S31635
X6CrNiMoNb17122 1.4580 Z6CND17.12 C (P) F-8M S31640
X10CrNiMoNb1812 1.4583 Z6CNDNb17.13 316Cb S31640
Welding dissimilar metals: mild steel or low alloyed steel to stainless CrNiMo-steel up to max. thickness of 12 mm.
Build up stainless overlays on mild or low alloyed steel.
max. 0.030 0.50 - 1.20 0.50 - 0.90 22.0 - 24.0 12.0 - 14.0 2.5 - 3.0 1222
Typical mech. properties
of weld metal Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.5 5090 36 1.2 81 4
3.2 90120 53 1.7 43 5
4.0 85180 56 2.5 28 6
* SDS available on request. ** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 300 84 1.7 095-699421 6
3.2 350 50 2.0 095-699439 6
4.0 350 35 2.0 095-699447 6
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
178
23/14-322 N
179
DUPLEX-325 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A5.4 EN-ISO 3581-A
E 2209-17 E 22 9 3 N L R 32
Approvals
DNV GL LR BV ABS
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
max. 0.030 0.50 - 1.20 0.50 - 0.90 21.5 - 23.0 8.5 - 10.5 2.7 - 3.3 25 - 40
Typical mech. properties
of weld metal Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 300 91 1.7 095-699454 6
3.2 350 55 2.0 095-699462 6
Re-drying temperature: 350 C (662 F) for two hours.
180
DUPLEX-325 N
Name Material
1. Hull. Mild steel.
2. Hull (Section weld). Mild steel.
3. Stiffeners to hull. Mild steel.
4. Stiffeners to Mild to Duplex.
bulkhead panel. Stainless steel.
5. Tanktop. Duplex stainless steel.
6a. Bulkhead panel. Duplex stainless steel.
(Section weld).
b. Bulkhead to cor- Duplex stainless steel.
rugated bulkhead
panel.
7. Bulkhead panel to Duplex stainless steel.
tanktop + corrugated
bulkhead panel to
tanktop.
8. Tanktop. Duplex stainless to mild
steel.
181
PICKLING GEL
Classifications
ASTM A-380 A1 BS CP-312
Caution: Storage temperatures higher than 45C must be avoided since they accelerate the ageing
process and destroy the product. Pickling chemicals give best result when they are fresh.
Chemical
composition Hydrofluoric acid Nitric Acid Binder
Vol. % (HF) HNO3
0,55 820 Rest
pH: 0 Flamable: No
Do not contain chloride containing agents such as hydrochloric acid (HCL)
Packaging
data Container Net Weight Product No. Containers
Content per container per container per carton
2 litre 2,5 kg 095-661778 including 4 brushes
Protective Users should wear rubber boots, protective gloves, rubber apron and face visor.
clothing
182
PICKLING GEL
During welding of stainless steel the 8. Pickling residuals and rinse water
weld and the adjacent area to the should be neutralised to pH-7 i.e. with
weld will become exposed to the air Neutralising Agent, and then rinsed with
at elevated temperature. The result water. For the deposit of heavy metals,
local water pollution control regulations
will be oxidation ranging from light should be consulted
tinting to a blue and black scale. A
corresponding chromium depletion 9. The bottles must be stored in an upright
position with the lid tightly closed.
in the metal below the oxide also Storing temperature 20C. Storage
occurs. If this is not removed, corro- temperature higher than 45C must be
sion will be the result. Unitor Pickling avoided since this accelerate the age-
Gel is used to remove this oxides and ing process.
the underlying chromium depleted
layer. It also removes surface micro Discoloration/oxidation of
slag particles and other contaminates Weld surface
which may cause local corrosion.
Pickling restores completely the
materials corrosion resistance. Chromium
depletion
Application
Pickling products are hazardous substanc-
es that must be handled with care. The
pickling area should be ventilated. Users
should wear protective gloves and face
visor. Ref.: Material Safety Data Sheet.
Stir the gel 3.01
1. Pretreat oxides; slag and weld defects
mechanically, preferably when the before use
welds are still warm and the weld
oxides less hard.
2. Give the area to be pickled time to cool
down to below 40C after welding.
3. Organic contaminants such as grease,
oil and paint have to be removed.
4. Stir the gel to a smooth consistency Apply with
and spread a thick layer on to the work the brush
piece using the brush supplied.
5. The work piece should be cold when
the gel is applied, although the air tem-
perature must not be below + 5C (41F).
Do not pickle in direct sunlight.
6. The gel should be allowed to remain
for at least 50 minutes. For Mo-alloyed Leave the paste
steels this time should be extended. If to work
necessary the gel may be allowed to
remain on the work piece over night as
there is no risk for corrosion.
7. After appropriate time, rinse off the
reminding gel using fresh water. If nec-
essary brush the weld with a stainless
steel wire brush.
Remove with water
183
NIFE-334 N
Imprint
Classifications
SFA/AWS A5.15 EN-ISO 1071
E NiFe-CL-A E NiFe-CL-A1
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+/-
PA PB PC PF PG PE, PD
Materials For welding and repair DIN 1691 DIN 1692 DIN 1693
to be welded G G 10 GTS-35-10 G GG-40
G G 15 GTS-45-06 G GG-50
G G 20 GTS-55-4 G GG-60
G G 25 GTW-35-04
G G 30 GTW-40-05
G G 35 GTW-45-07
GTW-S 38-12
3.01
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
3.2 75100 90 0.9 45 2
4.0 85160 70 1.8 30 3
* SDS available on request.
** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 68 2.2 096-699512 6
4.0 350 51 2.4 096-699520 6
Re-drying temperature: 200 C (392 F) for two hours.
184
NIFE-334 N
185
NICKEL-333 N
Classifications
SFA/AWS A5.15 EN-ISO 1071
E Ni-CL E Ni-CL3
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+/-
PA PB PC PF PG PE, PD
Materials For welding and repair DIN 1691 DIN 1692 DIN 1693
to be welded G G 10 GTS-35-10 G GG-40
G G 15 GTS-45-06 G GG-50
G G 20 GTS-55-4 G GG-60
G G 25 GTW-35-04
G G 30 GTW-40-05
G G 35 GTW-45-07
GTW-S 38-12
3.01
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
2.5 55110 50 0.8 90 2
3.2 80140 65 1.2 45 2
* SDS available on request.
** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
2.5 300 121 2.0 096-699496 6
3.2 350 68 2.2 096-699504 6
Re-drying temperature: 80 C (176 F) for two hours.
186
NICKEL-333 N
187
TINBRO-341
Unitor TINBRO-341
Classifications
AWS A5.6 DIN 8555
~ E Cu SnC E 30-UM-150-C
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
3.01
Rest 7.59.5 1
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time / Deposition rate Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal Danish Std.
3.2 7090 63 1.33 43 6
* SDS available on request.
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 42 1.4 096-606458 6
188
TINBRO-341
Yorcalbro
For dimensions up to approx. 4", braze
with AG-60 and Albro Flux 263 PF. For
larger dimensions, use TIG welding
with Ialbro 237 MF.
189
ALBRONZE-344
Unitor ALBRONZE-344
Classifications
AWS A5.6 DIN 8555
~ E Cu Al A2 E 31-UM-150-C
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
3.01
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time / Deposition rate Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal Danish Std.
3.2 80160 81 0.92 48 6
* SDS available on request.
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 46 1.3 096-606457 6
190
ALBRONZE-344
191
ALUMIN-351 N
Unitor ALUMIN-351 N
Classifications
EN-ISO 18273
EL-AlSi12
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
Materials For welding forged and cast aluminium alloy containing more than 7% Si as main alloying element.
to be welded G-Al Si 5 Mg (3.2341)
G-Al Si 10 Mg (3.2381)
G-Al Si 10 Mg (Cu) (3.2381)
G-Al Si 12 (3.2581)
G-Al Si 12 (Cu) (3.2583)
G-Al Si 11
G-Al Si 9 Mg
G-Al Si 9 Cu 3
3.01 G-Al Si 7 Mg
G-Al Si 6 Cu 4
Also applicable as surfacing electrode.
160 13
Welding data
Diameter Current Arc time **/ Deposition rate** Electrodes per Fume class*
mm. range, A electrode, sec. Kg/h kg weld metal** Danish Std.
3.2 70110 32 0.7 164 3
* SDS available on request.
** 90% of max. amperage
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 71 1.0 096-699538* 6
* This box is placed inside a vacuum metal pouch.
192
ALUMIN-351 N
Unitor ALUMIN-351 N is used for join- NB. When welding with Aluminium
ing and building up aluminium parts electrodes: Arrange suitable ventilation
with a thickness of more than 2 mm or use Fresh Air kit mounted in face
sheets, sections, tubes, pistons, cast- shield.
ings (covers), gangways, etc. When
welding materials more than 3 mm
thick, a 60 V-groove and an air gap of
13 mm should be used.
Grooves and the surrounding area
must be thoroughly cleaned. Thin
parts should be backed up before
welding. Cover plate ears welded back on
Use DC, positive polarity setting.
Large parts or castings should be
pre-heated to approx. 300C. Hold the
electrode almost vertically the work-
piece, the tip at a slight angle to the
weld direction. It is preferable to weld
in the flat position. Use as short arc as
possible and weld rapidly. If welding
is interrupted, remove the slag and
overlap the end of the bead by about 1
cm when re-striking. 3.01
All slag must be cleaned off the fin-
ished weld with brush and water.
Aluminium electrodes absorb moisture
very easily and must be stored in a dry, Hold the electrode almost at right angles
to the workpiece, or at a slight angle to the
preferably moisture-controlled, place.
weld direction
When first received the electrode box Note: Use the shortest possible arc.
is placed inside a vacuum metal pouch.
Aluminium or magnesium?
It may be difficult to determine wheth-
er a part is aluminium or magnesium.
Magnesium parts must not be welded
(magnesium bomb!). Use the following
test to determine whether a part is
aluminium or magnesium:
File a few shavings onto a small piece
of paper. Hold the paper over a flame.
If the fillings spark or seem to explode
in the flame, the material is magne-
sium. If there are only a few sparks Joining a cast aluminium cover. Such parts
here and there, and most of the fillings should be pre-heated to approx. 300C if
just glow, the material is aluminium possible
alloyed with magnesium, and may be
welded.
193
CH-2-382
Unitor CH-2-382
Classifications N.A.
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
AC
Welding positions DC+/-
PA PB PC PG PE, PD
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
3.2 350 36 1.4 096-606459 6
194
CH-2-382
Gouging Technique
1. Hold the electrode vertically and
press lightly against the workpiece.
The arc will strike after a few
seconds.
2. Hold the electrode at an angle of 1
1520 to the workpiece.
3. Direction of travel.
4. Warning!
Do not cut down into the work-
piece. Should this happen inadver- 2
tently, move the electrode back and
lower to correct angle.
5. Work downwards when cutting into
a vertical surface, otherwise as
shown in figures 13.
6. If a deeper groove is required, pro- 3
ceed as in this sketch.
3.01
195
ACA-384
Classifications N.A.
Approvals N.A.
Type of current
Welding data
Diameter Current Air pressure (bar) Fume class*
mm. range, Amps. (Consumption 400900 l/min) Danish Std.
6.3 200350 At electrode holder 69 (80 psi) 7
8.0 200450 At electrode holder 69 (80 psi) 7
15 x 5 400600 At electrode holder 69 (80 psi) 7
* SDS available on request.
Packaging data
Diameter Length Electrodes Net weight, Product No. Boxes
mm. mm. per box kg per box per box per carton
6.3 305 50 0.8 096-758474 5
8.0 305 50 1.3 096-758466 5
15 x 5 305 50 2.1 096-758458 5
Note: The copper coating will oxidize during the process, but this
will not influence the performance of the product.
196
ACA-384
197
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.01
198
TIG WELDING RODS ANDFLUXES
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
IMS-210 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
ICROMO-216 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
18/8 Mo-221 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
IDUPLEX-222 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
ICUNI-30-239 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
IALBRO-237 MF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
I-FLUX-238 PF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
3.02
199
tig welding rods ANDFLUXES
Introduction
In Tungsten Inert Gas welding (TIG), Regulator w/flow meter
an arc is struck between a Tungsten
electrode and the workpiece. An
inert gas flow (Argon) protects Gas hose
the electrode and pool from the
surrounding air. The electrodes Power source Argon
do not melt. The filler metal is cylinder
inserted into the molten pool
in the form of a separate
Return
rod. The process has cable
a similar welding
technique as gas
welding but use
electricity as Welding
energy source. cable
TIG Welding
torch
Rods for TIG welding
Unitor rods for TIG Welding are
supplied in sealed plastic containers.
All rods are supplied in 500 mm
lengths for convenient use. The label
3.02 on each container fully identifies the
contents, and also gives rod data and Gas
basic information on application areas shielding
and use.
Rod
Work piece
200
tig welding rods ANDFLUXES
Classification
Guide to AWSA5.28-1979
* C max. 0.05%
201
IMS 210
Description:
TIG welding rod for welding of unalloyed and low alloy creep
resistant 0.5% Mo steels and fine grained steels suitable
for working temperatures from 45C up to 550C. Also
recommended for welding of high tensile steels.
Identification:
Classification
AWS A5.28 EN 12070 DIN 8575 Werkstoff No.
ER 80 SG W MoSi SG Mo 1.5424
Type of current
ARGON
Welding positions DC- 69 l/min
Materials Boiler & pressure vessel steel DIN 17155 17Mn4, 19Mn5, 15Mo3
to be welded NF A36-205 A42 (CP, AP, FP), A48 (CP, AP, FP), A52 (CP, AP)
NF A36-206 15D3, 18MD4.05
BS 1501-261 0.5% Mo-types, plate, casting and forgings
3.02 Elevated temperature steel
Pipe material for elevated
DIN 17175 15Mo3, 15Mo5
St45.8, 15Mo3
temperatures
Fine grained steel DIN 17102 StE285 to StE400
NF A36-203 E275D, E355D, E390D, E430D
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Mn Si Mo Fe
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
570 480 23 At +20C = 180
At 45C = 47
Packaging data
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
2.0 500 150 1.5 097-604850
202
IMS 210
203
ICROMO 216
Description:
TIG welding rod for welding of low alloy creep and hydrogen resistant
Cr-Mo steels. Suitable for working temperatures up to 550C. Also
recommended for welding of high tensile steels.
Identification:
Copper coated.
Classification
AWS SFA 5.28 EN 12070 BS 2901 DIN 8575 Werkstoff No.
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Si Mn Cr Mo Fe
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile Elongation Impact value
Temperature Yield strength MPa
strength MPa % ISO-V(J)
Packaging data
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
2.5 500 56 1 097-305532
204
ICROMO 216
3.02
205
18/8 Mo 221
Description:
TIG welding rod with extra low carbon for welding stainless CrNiMo-steels.
Identification:
Classification
AWS A5.9 EN 12072 DIN 8556 Werkstoff No.
Type of current
ARGON
Welding positions DC- 69 l/min
Materials Steel grades BS 970 DIN 17440/1744.5 W.Nr. AFNOR NF A35- ASTM/ACI SIS UNS
to be welded 1554 573/574/576/582 A240/A312/A351
CF-3M J92800
Ext. low carb. 316S11 X2CrNiMo 17 13 2 1.4404 Z2CND 17.12 (TP) 316L 2353 S31603
C<0.03% CF-3M J92800
316S13 X2CrNiMo 18 14 3 1.4435
X2CrNiMoN 17 2 2 1.4406 Z2CND 17.12lN (TP) 316LN S31653
Med carbon 316S31 X2CrNiMoN 17 12 2 1.4401 Z6CND 17.11 316 (TP) 316 (2347) S31600/
C>0.03% 316S33 X5CrNiMo17 13 3 1.4436 Z6CND 17.12 2343 S30409
316S33 G-X6CrNiMo 18 12 1.4437 Z6CND 17.12 C(P)F-8M J92900
3.02 316S33 G-X10CrNiMo18 9 1.4410
316S33 G-X6CrNiMo 18 10 1.4408 Z6CND 17.12 C(P)F-8M J92900
Ti.Nb- 320S31 X6CrNiMoTi 17 12 2 1.4571 Z6CNDT 17.12 316Ti (2344) S32100/S31635
stabilized
347S31 X6CrNiNb 18 10 1.4450 Z6CNNb17.12 (T) 347 2338 34700/S34709
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Mn Si Cr Ni Mo Fe
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile Yield strength MPa Elongation Impact value
strength MPa % ISO-V(J)
Packaging data
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
2.0 500 42 0.5 097-602979
206
18/8 Mo 221
Argon hose
Small hole
to let the
gas escape
Backing gas used to prevent oxidization
inside pipes.
207
IDUPLEX-222
Identification:
Classification
AWS A5.9 EN 12072 DIN 8556 Werkstoff No.
Type of current
ARGON
Welding positions DC- 69 l/min
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
Packaging data
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
2,0 500 42 0,5 097-725309
208
IDUPLEX-222
209
ICUNI 30 239
Description:
TIG welding rod for welding of copper-nickel alloys (cunifer, cupronickel
pipes) containing up to 31% Ni.
Identification:
Classification
AWS A5.7 BS 2901 DIN 1733 Werkstoff No.
ER Cu Ni C 18 WSG-Cu Ni 30 Fe 2.0837
Type of current
ARGON
Welding positions DC- 79 l/min
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) Ni Mn Fe Ti Cu
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Hardness
MPa MPa % HB
Packaging data
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
2.5 500 92 2.0 097-335547
210
ICUNI 30 239
211
IALBRO 237 MF
Description:
Flux-coated TIG welding rod for welding
of aluminium-brass pipes also known as
Yorcalbro pipes.
Identification:
Classification
AWS A5.7 DIN 1733
ER Cu A1-A2 SG-CuAI8Ni2
Type of current
ARGON
Welding positions DC- 79 l/min
Flux I-FLUX 238 PF, 250 gram container, order No. 097-603092.
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) AL Mn Ni Cu
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Hardness
MPa MPa % HB
Packaging data
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
2.4 500 81 1.4 097-519736
212
IALBRO 237 MF
213
I-FLUX 238PF
Description:
Flux for TIG welding rod IALBRO-237 MF for use on Yorkalbro.
Identification:
Application Apply with brush. Use as additional flux on both sides of the joint, especially on the inside of pipes.
Working area should be adequately ventilated.
The flux is corrosive. Remove with brush and hot water after brazing.
250 097-603092
214
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.02
215
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.02
216
WIRES FOR WIRE WELDING
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Storage and handling for Flux Cored wires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
GPS-W-200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
MS-W-201 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
HST-SF-232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
S 316 M-GF-221 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
S 309 M-GF-222 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Icuni-W-239 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
Ialbro-W-237 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Alumag-W-235 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Abratech-W-230 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
3.03
217
WIRESFORWIREWELDING
Introduction
In Wire welding an arc is struck Regulator w/flow meter
between a continuosly fed wire and
the workpiece. An inert gas, active Gas hose
gas or a mixture of the two protects Cylinder
Argon
the pool from the surrounding air. CO2
Wire feeder
The wire used can be solid or flux Power source Argon + CO2
cored. In some cases the flux
Spool
cored wire is self shielded Return
and does not require cable
any additional
Wire welding
shielding gas. torch
218
WIRESFORWIREWELDING
Classification
Guide to AWS A5.18-1993
219
WIRESFORWIREWELDING
Classification
Guide to AWS A5.20-1995
E 7 1 T -1 M
220
WIRESFORWIREWELDING
221
GPS W 200
Description:
Solid wire for GMA welding of structural steels.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A 5. 18 EN 440 DIN 8559 Werkstoff No.
Type of current
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PG PE, PD
Shielding gas
ARGON +20% CO2 or
pure CO2
1015 l/min.
Materials General structural steel DIN 17100 St33, St37-2 to St52-3
to be welded NF A35-501 A33, A43-2, E24-2 (4 to E36 2 (4)
BS 4360 50D, 43D
Ship plates Grade A, B, C, D, E, AH, DH, EH
Pipe material DIN 17172 StE210.7, StE240.7, StE290.7, StE320.7, StE360.7
API 5 LX X42, X46, X52, X60
DIN 1626-1630 St37.0/4, St44.0/4, St52.0/4
Boiler & pressure DIN 17155 HI, HII, 17Mn4, 19Mn5
vessel steel NF A 36-205 A37 (CP, AP), A42 (CP, AP), A48 (CP, AP), A52 (CP, AP)
BS 3059 Part 1 HPS 33
Elevated temperature steel NF A36-207 A510AP, A530AP, A550AP
DIN 17175 St35.8, St45.8
Fine grained steel DIN 17102 StE255 to StE420
NF A36-203 E275D, E355D, E390D, E430D, E445D
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Mn Si S P Fe
3.03
0.08 1.4 0.85 0.03 0.025 Rest
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
At +20C = >120
510 430 22 At 20C = 70
Welding data
Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
Wire speed Volt Stick out rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
7.5 m/min 22 V 1020 mm 0.672.68 1.05 1
Packaging data
Diameter Spool size Net weight Product No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
222
GPS W 200
3.03
223
MS-W-201 SELFSHIELD
Description:
General Purpose Self-Shielded Electrode wire for the welding
of mild steel and ships steel. All position welding, including vertical down.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A 5.20 EN
E 71 T-GS
Type of current
Welding positions DC-
PA PB PC PF PG PE, PD
Shielding gas
No shielding gas
required.
Materials General structural steel DIN 17100 St33, St37-2 to St44-3
to be welded NF A35-501 A33, A34-2, E24-2 (4), E28-2 (3) E30-2 (3)
BS 4360 Gr. 40A-C, 43A-C
Ship plates Grade A, B, C, D
Cast steel DIN 1681 GS38
Pipe material DIN 17172 StE210.7, StE240.7, StE290.7, StE320.7, StE360.7
API 5 LX X42, X46
DIN 1626-1630 St37.0/4, St44.0/4
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Mn Si P S Al Fe
3.03 0.23 0.7 0.4 0.007 0.01 2 Rest
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength
MPa
615
Welding data
Wire speed Volt Stick out Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
12 m/min. . 20 V 9,5 mm 0.40.7 1.3 7
Packaging data
Diameter Spool size Net weight Product No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
224
MS-W-201 SELFSHIELD
Typical applications
General plate welding, including hull
plate and stiffener welding on ships.
3.03
225
HST-SF 232 SELFSHIELD
Description:
General Purpose Self-Shielded Electrode wire for the welding of
mild steel and ships steel.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A5.20 EN BS 7084 DIN NEN-ISO NFA 81-350
Type of current
Welding positions DC-
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
Shielding gas
No shielding gas
required.
Materials General structural steel DIN 17100 St33, St37-2 to St52-3
to be welded NF A35-501 A33, A43-2, E24-2 (-4) to E36-2 (-4)
BS 4360 Grade 43D, 50D
Ship plates Grade A, B, C, D, E, AH, DH, EH
Cast steel DIN 1681 GS38, GS45, GS52
BS100 A1, A2, A3, AM1, AM2, AW1
Pipe material DIN 17172 StE210.7, StE240.7, StE290.7, StE320.7, StE360.7
API 5 LX X42, X46, X52, X60
DIN 1626-1630 St37.0/4, St44.0/4, St52.0/4
Boiler & pressure vessel steel DIN 17155 HI, HII, 17Mn4, 19Mn5
NF A 36-205 A37 (CP, AP), A42 (CP, AP), A48 (CP, AP), A52 (CP, AP)
NF A36-207 A510AP, A530AP, A550AP
BS 1501 151/154/161/164-Gr. 360 to 223/224/225-Gr. 490
Elevated temperature steel DIN 17175 St35.8, St45.8
Fine grained steel DIN 17102 StE255 to StE420
NF A36-203 E275D, E355D, E390D, E430D, E445D
3.03 Low temperature steel SEW 680-70 TTSt35, TTSt41, TTSt45
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Mn Si P S Al
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
Welding data
Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
Wire speed
Volt Stick out rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
226
HST-SF 232 SELFSHIELD
Typical applications:
General plate welding, including hull 3.03
plate and stiffener welding on ships,
rebuilding pitting corrosion in cargo
and ballast tanks.
227
S 316 M-GF 221
Description:
Flux cored wire for welding of stainless steel: 19% Cr/12% Ni/3% Mo types.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A5.22 EN 12073 Werkstoff No.
Type of current
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PG
Shielding gas
ARGON +20% CO2 or For posistion welding preferred
pure CO2 Ar + CO2 Mix.
2225 l/min.
Materials Steel grades BS 970 DIN 17440/1745 W.Nr. AFNOR NF A35- ASTM/ACI SIS UNS
to be welded 1554 573/574/576/582 A240, A312, A351
Ext. low carb. 316S11 X2CrNiMo 17 13 2 1.4404 Z2CND 17.12 (TP) 316L 2353 S31603
C<0.03% CF-3M J92800
316S13 X2CrNiMo 18 14 3 1.4435
X2CrNiMoN 17 12 2 1.4406 Z2CND 17.12 lN (TP) 316LN S31653
X2CrNiMoN 17 13 3 1.4429 Z2CND 17.13 lN
Med. carbon 316S31 X5CrNiMo 17 12 2 1.4401 Z6CND 17.11 316 (TP) 316 (2347) S31600/
C>0.03% 316S33 X5CrNiMo17 13 3 1.4436 Z6CND 17.12 2343 S30409
316S33 G-X6CrNiMo 18 12 1.4437 Z6CND 17.12 C(P)F-8M J92900
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Si Mn Cr Ni Mo Fe
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
510 350 30 At +20C = 47
-120C = 32
Welding data
Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
Wire speed
Volt Stick out rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
11 m/min 22 V 1525 mm 1.23.2 1.10 7
Packaging data
Diameter Coil size Net weight Product No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
228
S 316 M-GF 221
3.03
229
S 309 M-GF 222
Description:
Flux cored wire for welding of stainless steel and welding
mild steel to stainless steel. Also welding of clad steel.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A5.22 EN 12073 DIN 8556-86 Werkstoff No.
Type of current
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PG
Shielding gas
ARGON +20% CO2 or For posistion welding preferred
pure CO2 Ar + CO2 Mix.
2225 l/min.
Materials Steel grades BS 970 DIN 17440 W.Nr. AFNOR ASTM/ACI SIS UNS
to be welded First layer in 316S11 X2CrNiMo 17 13 2 1.4404 Z2CND 17.12 (TP) 316L 2353 S31603
CrNiMo- CF-3M J92800
claddings 316S13 X2CrNiMo 18 14 3 1.4435
X2CrNiMoN 17 12 2 1.4406 Z2CND 17.12 lN (TP) 316LN S31653
X2CrNiMoN 17 13 3 1.4429 Z2CND 17.13 lN
316S31 X5CrNiMo 17 12 2 1.4401 Z6CND 17.11 316 (TP) 316 (H) (2347) S31600/
316S33 X5CrNiMo 17 13 3 1.4436 Z6CND 17.12 2343 S30409
320S31 G-X6CrNiMoTi 17 12 2 1.4571 Z6CNDT 17.12 316Ti (2344) S31635/
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Mn Si Cr Ni Mo Fe
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
550 450 25 At +20C = >47
60C = 32
Welding data
Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
Wire speed
Volt Stick out rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
13 m/min 24 V 1525 mm 1.23.2 1.10 7
Packaging data
Diameter Spool size Net weight Product No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
230
S 309 M-GF 222
3.03
231
ICUNI W 239
Description:
Solid wire for GMA welding of copper-nickel alloys containing 1030% Ni.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A5.7 DIN 1733 Werkstoff No.
Type of current
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
Shielding gas
ARGON
1520 l/min.
Chemical composition
3.03 as welded (W%) Mn Ni Fe Ti Cu
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Hardness
MPa MPa % HB
Welding data
Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
Wire speed
Volt Stick out rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
7.5 m/min 22 V 810 mm 1.22.80 1.05 1
Packaging data
Diameter Spool size Net weight Product No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
232
ICUNI W 239
3.03
233
IALBRO W 237
Description:
Solid wire for GMA welding of copper-aluminium alloys e.g.Yorcalbro.
High resistance to corrosion and wear.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A5.7 DIN 1733 Werkstoff No.
Type of current
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF PE, PD
Shielding gas
ARGON
1520 l/min.
3.03
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) Mn AI Cu
1.0 8 Rest
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Hardness Melting range
MPa MPa % HB C
Welding data
Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
Wire speed
Volt Stick out rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
7.5 m/min 22 V 810 mm 1.432.63 1.05 1
Packaging data
Diameter Spool size Net weight Product No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
234
IALBRO W 237
3.03
235
ALUMAG W 235
Description:
Solid wire for GMA welding of aluminium alloys with maximum 5% Mg.
Wire identification:
Classification
AWS A5.10 DIN 1732 Werkstoff Nr.
Type of current
Welding positions DC+
PA PB PC PF
Shielding gas
ARGON
1520 l/min.
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) Mn Ti Mg Cr Al
3.03
0.4 <0.15 5.0 0.15 Rest
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation
MPa MPa %
240 110 17
Welding data
Deposition Kg wire/kg Fume class*
Wire speed
Volt Stick out rate kg/h weldmetal SS-062802
12 m/min 23 V 810 mm 0.691.57 1.05 1
Packaging data
Diameter Spool size Net weight Product No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
1 200 x 55 2 090-590083
236
ALUMAG W 235
237
ABRATECH-W-230
ABRATECH-W-230
ABRATECH-W-230
Description:
Self Shielded Flux Cored Wire for Hard Surfacing
Description:
Self Shielded
Description:
Wire Flux Cored Wire for Hard Surfacing
identification:
Self Shielded Flux Cored Wire for Hard Surfacing
Tubular Flux Cored Wire on spool
Wire identification:
Wire identification:
Tubular Flux Cored Wire on spool
Classifications DIN 8555
Tubular Flux Cored Wire on spool
Classifications MF 10-60
DIN 8555
Classifications DIN10-60
MF 8555
Approvals MFN.A.
10-60
Approvals N.A.
Type Approvals
of current N.A.
AC
Type of
Welding current
positions DC+/-
AC
Type of current
Welding positions AC
DC+/- PA PB PC
Welding positions DC+/- PA PB PC
Shielding gas
No shielding PA
gas PB PC
Shielding gas required
Shielding gas
No shielding gas
required
No shielding gas
Materials required Low/medium carbon steels,
Hard surfacing of:
to be welded Austenitic manganese steel with 12- 14 %
Materials Hard surfacing of: Mn
Low/medium carbon steels,
to be welded
Materials Hard surfacing of: Austenitic manganese
Low/medium steel with 12- 14 %
carbon steels,
Mn
to be welded Austenitic manganese steel with 12- 14 %
Mn
Chemical C Mn Si Cr B
composition
4,5 0,5 1 26 0,4
as welded (W %)
Chemical C Mn Si Cr B
composition
Chemical C Mn Si Cr B
4,5 0,5 1 26 0,4
as welded (W %)
composition
Mechanical Hardness
4,5 0,5 1 26 0,4
as welded (W %)
properties as HRC
welded
Mechanical Hardness
60
HRC
properties as
3.03 Mechanical
welded
Hardness
HRC
properties as 60
welded Wire speed/Voltage Stick out Deposition
Welding data 60 rate Kg wire/kg Fume class *
SC 12 RC mm Kg/h Deposition
weldmetal Kg wire/kg Fume
SS-062802 class*
Wire speed Volt Stick out rate
Welding data Wire speed/Voltage Stick out Deposition rate Kg kg/h
wire/kg weldmetal SS-062802
Fume class *
8,5m/min
Wire
/ 32 V
SC 12speed/Voltage
RC 10
mm out
Stick
5,7
Kg/h
Deposition rate
6.3
weldmetal
Kg wire/kg
7SS-062802
Fume class *
Welding data SC 8.5 m/min 32 V 10 mm 5.7 6.3 SS-062802 7
12 RC mm Kg/h weldmetal
8,5m/min / 32 V 10 5,7 6.3 7
Packaging data Diameter
8,5m/min / 32 V 10 Spool size 5,7 Net weight6.3 Product7No.
mm mm per spool kg per spool
Packaging data Diameter
1,6 Spool
300 size
X 100 Net weight
15 Product No.
090-230230
Packaging data mm
Diameter mm size
Spool per spool
Net weightkg per spoolNo.
Product
mm
1,6 mm
300 X 100 per spool kg
15 per spool
090-230230
1,6 300 X 100 15 090-230230
238
ABRATECH-W-230
ABRATECH-W-230
General information
Unitor Abratech-W-230 is a hard surfacing self shielded
flux cored wire with excellent resistance to abrasive
wear under moderate impact and pressure. The wire
deposit chromium carbides in an austenitic matrix.
Dredger Buckets
Connect the torch to + polarity. There is no need for
shielding gas because the wire is a shelf shielded flux
cored wire producing its own gas protection. Weld
using a small weaving motion from side to side. The
required hardness is obtained in one layer. There is no 3.03
slag to be removed after welding.
Wear plates
Areas of application:
Protection of surfaces subject to extreme wear and
abrasion caused by solids or slurry. Specifically meant
for dredgers and cement carriers facing heavy abra-
sion combined with medium and light impact.
239
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.03
240
GAS WELDING RODS AND FLUXES
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
MS-200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Alumag-235 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Aluflux-234 F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
3.04
241
GAS WELDING RODS AND FLUXES
Top valve
Introduction Regulator
Gas welding utilizes the high flame
temperature in the oxy-acetylene Flashback
arrestors
flame (3100 C) to melt the base
material.
Cylinder
Hoses
Welding
Filler rod attachment Shank
Leftward welding.
For material thickness up to 3.2 mm
3.04 (1/8 in) use Leftward welding.
242
GAS WELDING RODS AND FLUXES
Oxidizing flame.
243
MS 200
Description
Gas welding rod for welding of unalloyed and low alloyed
structural steel with a carbon content of less than 0.2%.
Identification
Copper coated steel rod.
Classification
AWS / A 5.2 EN12536 BS 1453 DIN 8554
R 60 OII A 2 61121
Flame setting
Neutral
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) C Si Mn S P Fe
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Impact value
MPa MPa % ISO-V (J)
3.04 390440 300 20 +20C = 50
Packaging data
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
244
MS 200
45
245
ALUMAG 235
Description
Gas welding rod for wrought and cast aluminium alloys containing up to 5% Mg.
Generally it can be used for all cast alloys containing magnesium as the main
alloying element.
Identification
Imprint 5356 ALMG 5
Classification
AWS A5.10 DIN 1732 Werkstoff No.
Flame setting
Slight
acetylene
surplus
Chemical composition
as welded (W%) Mn Ti Mg Cr Al
3.04 0.4 <0.15 5.0 0.15 Rest
Mechanical properties
as welded Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Melting range
MPa MPa % C
246
ALUMAG 235
247
ALUFLUX 234 F
Description
Flux for gas welding rod Alumag-235 on aluminium.
Identification
White flux in powder form inside container.
Application Mix to a paste with distilled water and apply with brush on rod and joint edges.
The flux is corrosive. Remove with brush and hot water after brazing.
Packaging data
Gross weight in grams Product No.
250 092-603043
* SDS available on request..
3.04
248
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.04
249
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.04
250
BRAZING RODS AND FLUXES
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Bronze-264 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
FC-Bronze-261 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
FC-Wearbro-262 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
FC-Cast Iron-268 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
AG-45-253 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
AG-60-252 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Tin-241 AG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Fluxes for Brazing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Bronze Flux-261 PF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Wearbro Flux-262 PF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
AG-60/45 Flux-252 PF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Albro Flux-263 PF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
3.05
251
BRAZINGRODSANDFLUXES
252
BRAZINGRODSANDFLUXES
If the bonding temperature is below In Capillary Brazing the alloys are thin
400C the method is termed Soldering. flowing in consistency (Silver brazing)
If the bonding temperature is above and they are ideal for use in capillary
400C the method is called Brazing. joints.
Brazing can further be divided into
Capillary brazing/Silver brazing and
Braze welding.
In Braze welding the alloys are mostly
thick floating in consistency and the
joint preparation like in welding.
Brazing Methods
Soldering Brazing
400C
Typical Capillary/Silver brazing joints. Note that they all utilise capillary action.
253
BRAZINGRODSANDFLUXES
254
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.05
255
BRONZE 264
Description
An easy-flowing, universal brazing bronze (brass) rod for the
brazing of steel, cast iron, copper and copper alloys, nickel and
nickel alloys. It gives a very smooth and attractive surface. The
addition of Si, Mn and Sn guarantees a strong and high-quality
deposit.
Identification
Bare bronze coloured rod.
Classification
AWS A5.8 EN 1044 BS 1453/1845 DIN 8513 Werkstoff. No.
Classification
Flame setting
Neutral or
slight oxygen
surplus.
Chemical composition
approx. (%) Cu Mn Si Sn Al Ni Zn
5 500 36 3 093-514240
256
BRONZE 264
Melt of a drop.
Move the torch in a circle until the drop
melts and flows outwards.
257
FC BRONZE 261
Description
A flux-coated brazing rod for joining and surfacing copper, brass, bronze,
aluminium bronze, cast iron and steel. May be used for brazing galvanized
steel without destroying the galvanized surface.
Identification
Classification
NF A 81-362 ISO 3677
59 C 1 B Cu 59 ZnAgSi 870-890
Type of joint
Flame setting
Neutral or
slight oxygen
surplus.
Working range
Working temperature C Solidus-Liquidus C
890 870890
Chemical composition
approx. (%) Cu Mn Sn Ag Zn
450550 30 125
Packaging data
Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
2 500 69 1 093-233551
3 500 32 1 093-233569
258
FC BRONZE 261
259
FC WEARBRO 262
Description
A flux-coated wear-resistant bronze rod used for applying a
hard-wearing surface to bronze, brass, copper, steel, cast iron
and malleable cast iron. Also used for braze welding cast iron.
Identification
Classification
ISO 3677
Type of joint
Flame setting
Neutral or
slight oxygen
surplus.
Working range
Working temperature C Solidus-Liquidus C
910 890920
Chemical composition
approx. (%) Cu Ni Zn
49 10 Rest
3.05
Mechanical properties
Tensile strength Elongation Hardness
MPa % HB
Packaging data
Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
3 500 33 1 093-233577
260
FC WEARBRO 262
261
FC CAST IRON 268 S
Description
Flux coated rod for joining and surfacing cast iron and
brazing cast iron to steel. Oil impregnated cast iron may
also be brazed with FC-Castiron 268 S.
Identification
Classification N.A.
Type of joint
Flame setting
Slight oxygen
surplus.
Working range
Working temperature C Solidus-Liquidus C
1170 11501190
Chemical composition
approx. (%) C Si Mn Ni Fe
Mechanical properties
Tensile strength Hardness
MPa HB
250320 185
3.05
Packaging data
Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
262
FC CAST IRON 268 S
263
AG 45 253
Description
Bare cadmium free silver rod for joining of all types of steel,
stainless steel, copper, copper alloys, nickel and nickel alloys,
cast iron and hard metals. This brazing rod gives a very good
joint and can be used for brazing nipples, sleeves and unions to
copper pipes.
Identification
Classification
ISO 3677 DIN 8513
Type of joint
Flame setting
Neutral.
Working range
Working temperature C Solidus-Liquidus C
730 680740
Chemical composition
approx. (%) Cu Ag Zn
3.05 30 44 Rest
Mechanical properties
Tensile strength Elongation Hardness
MPa % HB
400480 20 130
Packaging data
Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
264
AG 45 253
265
AG 60 252
Description
A flux coated cadmium free, seawater resistant, high strenth silver
rod for joining all types of steel, stainless steel, copper, copper
alloys, nickel, nickel alloys, cast iron, Yorcalbro pipes (aluminium-
brass), cunifer pipes type 90/10 and 70/30.
Identification
Classification
ISO 3677 DIN 8513
Type of joint
Flame setting
Neutral.
Working range
Working temperature C Solidus-Liquidus C
650 630660
Chemical composition
approx. (%) Cu Ag Sn Zn
21 55 2.5 Rest
Mechanical properties
Tensile strength Elongation Hardness
MPa % HB
430 25 130
Packaging data
Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
266
AG 60 252
267
TIN 241 AG
Description
Flux cored lead free silver alloyed soft solder wire on
spool for tinning and joining of electric conductors,
electrical connections, electrical instruments, radios,
batteries, refrigeration plants, etc.
Identification
Classification
DIN EN 61190
Type of joint
Flame setting
Preferably use soldering
iron. If welding torch:
Soft reducing flame.
Working range
Working temperature C Melting range C
230 217
Chemical composition
approx. (%) Sn Ag Cu
Mechanical properties
Tensile strength
MPa
90 (Ms 58)
Packaging data
Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product No.
mm. mm. per package per package kg per package
268
TIN 241 AG
269
BRAZINGRODSANDFLUXES
270
BRONZEFLUX261 PF
Description
Flux for brazing rod Bronze-264 and FC-Bronze-261.
Identification
Packaging data
Gross weight in grams Product No.
250 093-603076
3.05
271
WEARBRO FLUX 262 PF
Description
Flux for brazing rod FC-Wearbro 262.
Identification
Packaging data
Gross weight in grams Product No.
250 093-603068
3.05
272
AG 60/45 FLUX 252 PF
Description
Flux for silver brazing rods AG-60-252 and AG-45-253.
Identification
Packaging data
Gross weight in grams Product No.
250 093-778461
3.05
273
ALBRO FLUX 263 PF
Description
Flux for silver brazing rod AG-60-252 on Yorcalbro.
Identification
Packaging data
Gross weight in grams Product No.
250 093-604371
3.05
274
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.05
275
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.05
276
cold repair compounds
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Typical application areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
How do Cold Repairs work? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
How to prepare the surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
How to apply the product . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Cold Repair Kit-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Product overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
Leak Stop Pipe repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Metalgrade Ready-Stick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Metalgrade Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
Metalgrade Rebuild . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
Metalgrade Hi-Temp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Aquagrade Rebuild . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
Ceramigrade Rebuild . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Ceramigrade Liner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Ceramigrade Abrashield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
Rubbergrade 6 Rebuild . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324
Rubbergrade 6 Remould . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
3.06
277
cold repairCOMPOUNDS
Introduction
Unitor Metalgrade and Ceramigrade excellent chemical resistance and
products are a range of cold curing are suitable for permanent immersion
metal repair and rebuilding materials in many environments including
based on the latest polymer resin seawater, hydrocarbons, oils and
technology which is the result of a very wide range of chemical
many years of development. solutions.
Unitor Rubbergrade products are The basic range of products is
cold-vulcanising elastomeric repair selected in order to provide a
materials for use on rubber as well as versatile program for on-board
metal components. applications. The application
areas complement and extend the
The products are compatible with
various welding and related thermal
all ferrous and non-ferrous metals
processes already in use, providing
as well as most plastics, and have
an even more complete repair system
in many cases proved themselves
than previously.
as permanent repairs. They have
278
cold repairCOMPOUNDS
279
coldREPAIRCOMPOUNDS
280
coldREPAIRCOMPOUNDS
3.06
Roughening increases the Most castings have an open
surface area and gives a structure that contaminants
better key can penetrate into.
281
coldREPAIRCOMPOUNDS
282
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
283
POLYMERCOLD REPAIR KIT-A
284
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
285
PRODUCTOVERVIEW
Repair Set
Each set comes complete with all necessary
application equipment technical data sheets
and Health & Safety Data sheets.
Metalgrade Base and activator in two separate sticks. Cut off the
Ready Stick needed length and knead the two parts together till
Set streak free. Use for sealing of leaks in pipes, tanks,
ducts etc. Can be used together with Leak Stop to plug
the hole before wrapping the tape.
Set of 3 pairs of sticks giving: 0,72 kg Repair Compound 0,86 kg 101-659227
286
PRODUCTOVERVIEW
287
LEAK STOP
Product
Description Product name/ Kit consists of: Application
Product No./Kit weight
Leak Stop I 1 pc. 2"x4' (50 mm x 1,2 m) For use on pipe diameter 01"
100-630384 / 158 g.e black repair tape in a pouch (0 mm25 mm)
Leak Stop II 1 pc. 2"x12' (50 mm x 3,6 m) For use on pipe diameter 1"2"
100-606006 / 232 g.e black repair tape in a pouch (25 mm50 mm)
Leak Stop III 1 pc. 4"x12' (100 mm x 3,6 m) For use on pipe diameter 2"4"
100-630392 / 325 g.e black repair tape in a pouch (50 mm100 mm)
With all kits comes 1 x pair of Gloves, 1 pc. Working data sheet, 1 pc. Safety Data Sheet
Identification
Grey knitted fibreglass tape
Application data
Mixing ratio Pot life (mins) (working life)
Initial setting 5
Technical data
18 Gauge knitted fibreglass
Service temperatures
Dry heat Minimum temp.
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals.
Health and Safety As long as good practise is observed Leak Stop can be safely used. Wearing of rubber gloves is
advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet provided with
each packaged product.
288
LEAK STOP
1. Surface preparation
Remove all pressure from the pipe,
including gravity fed drip. For active Rough score surface
leaks when pressure cannot be
removed:Holes should be stopped
using a pipe repair clamp. Remove oil,
grease, loose rust scale, sealant tape
and paint from repair area. Rough
score a four inch (10 cm) path 360
around the pipe centring leak site.
Leak Stop works best on a rough
surface. If the pipe surface is pitted
by rust, remove the loose scale. If the
surface is smooth, as with copper or
Water activate Leak Stop
stainless, you must roughen the area
with a coarse file, rasp or saw blade.
For plastic pipe, the external mould
release must be removed.
Abrade surfaces with a coarse grit
sandpaper. A saw blade must also 3.06
be used to create a cross hatch
pattern. This is particularly useful on
polypropylene and PVDF piping.
2. Mixing
Position over leak site
During mixing and application gloves
should be worn at all times to protect NOTE:Water activates the
the hands. resins, so apply entire roll as
Open pouch at the notch, remove any amount remaining cannot
Leak Stop Repair Tape, submerge the be saved. WORKINGTIMEis
roll in water and squeeze two or three three to five minutes. So
times, for about five seconds. BEPREPAREDTOWORKSWIFTLY.
289
LEAKSTOP
3. Application
Remove roll from water and wrap
quickly and tightly as follows:Centre
tape over leak site, wrap from bottom
of roll, pulling firmly throughout
application. After 57 plies, you will
observe resin foam coming through
the tape which is desirable and aided
by pulling tightly. Continue until entire
roll is applied, building to a minimum Wrap while pulling firmly
thickness of 1/2 inch (12 mm) and use
a second roll if necessary.
Firmly press and smooth end of
roll into wrap in the direction of
application. Wet gloves in water,
smooth and firmly press the wet resin
back into the wrap.
KEEP HANDS MOVING QUICKLY AND
WET GLOVES FREQUENTLY TO AVOID
STICKING
Continue rapid hand movement Wet gloves, smooth out
pressing and polishing resin in
motions around and parallel to the
pipe. Continue process until resins are
no longer tacky. A fully detailed Material Safety Data
The repair should now have a smooth Sheet is included with the set.
hard surface and an enamel-like The information provided in this
appearance with no fibreglass instruction for use sheet is intended
substance showing throught the as a general guide only. Users
resins. should determine the suitability of
the product for their own particular
3.06 NOTE:If thicker application is needed
purposes by their own tests.
spend a little less time finishing the
first roll and immediately begin the
application of the next. Finish the final
roll as if a single roll application.
4. Cleaning
After application dispose of gloves.
290
LEAK STOP
Leak Stop I 1 pc. 2" x 4' (50 mm x 1,2 m) black repair tape in a pouch.
100-630384 For use on pipe diameter 01" (025 mm).
If used outside this diameter area:
Nominal Number of
Pipe Size Leak Stop Irolls
Leak Stop II 1 pc. 2" x 12' (50 mm x 3,6 m) black repair tape in a pouch.
100-606006 For use on pipe diameter 1"2" (2550 mm).
Leak Stop III 1 pc. 4" x 12' (100 mm x 3,6 m) black repair tape in a pouch.
100-630392 For use on pipe diameter 2"4" (50100 mm).
If used outside this diameter area:
Nominal Number of
Pipe Size Leak Stop Irolls
291
METALGRADE READY-STICK
Identification
Activator Component Base Component
Appearance Colour Appearance Colour
Putty Beige /Brown Putty Black
Application
Data Mixing Ratio Mixing Ratio Pot Life (mins)
Volume Weight (Working Life)
Activator Base Activator Base 5 C 10 C 15C 20 C 25 C 30 C 35 C 40 C
1 1 1 1 30 25 20 15 15 12 10 5
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 15 mm thickness
1,95 1,96 1,96 100 500 Excellent
Phys/Mec
Properties Compressive Strength ASTM D412 70 MPa 10200 psi
Tensile Shear Adhesion ASTM D412 8 MPa 1200 psi
3.06
Abrasion Resistance ASTM D4060 -
Corrosion Resistance ASTM B117 > 5000 hours
Hardness (Shore D) ASTM D2246 80
Impact Resistance ASTM D256 > 5 kJ/m2
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 90 C / 195 F + 80 C / 176 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practise is observed MetalGrade Ready-Stick can be safely used. Wearing of
rubber gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
292
METALGRADE READY-STICK
293
METALGRADE READY-STICK
3. Application
Prepared Surfaces should be dry. The
mixed material should be pressed
firmly onto the prepared area, working
the material into any cracks or
surface defects.
When MetalGrade Ready-Stick is
used to repair leaking pipes, the
flow through the pipe should be
discontinued until the repair is made
and the MetalGrade Ready-Stick is Pipe Joints
set. Any leaking fluid must be wiped
from the prepared surface before
undertaking the repair.
4. Machining
Once the MetalGrade Ready-Stick
has cured for the minimum time
indicated in the Curing Properties
Section of the product specification
sheet, sanding, grinding and
machining etc. can be carried out
using standard engineering practices.
Hole in small diameter pipe
5. Cleaning
All equipment should be cleaned
IMMEDIATELY after each use with
a cleaner. Failure to follow this
procedure will result in application
equipment becoming unusable.
3.06
6. Health and safety
As long as normal good practices
are observed MetalGrade Ready-
Stick can be safely used. A fully
detailed Material Safety Data Sheet is
included with the set.The information
provided in this Instruction for use
sheet is intended as a general guide
only. Users should determined the
suitability of the product for their
own particular purposes by their own
tests. Valve taps
294
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
295
METALGRADE EXPRESS
Product specification sheet Metalgrade Express
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 15 mm thickness
1,6 1,8 1,7 100 585 Excellent
Phys/Mec
Properties Compressive Strength ASTM D695 47 MPa 7000 psi
Tensile Shear Adhesion ASTM D1002 18,5 MPa 2700 psi
3.06 Flexural Strength ASTM D790 48 MPa 6600 psi
Corrosion Resistance ASTM B117 5000 hours
Hardness (Shore D) ASTM D2246 78
Hardness (Rockwell R) ASTM D785 100
Dielectric Strength ASTM D149 30 volts/mil
Surface Resistivity ASTM D257 1 x 109 Ohm/cm
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 80 C / 176 F + 70 C / 158 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed MetalGrade Express can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
296
METALGRADE EXPRESS
297
METALGRADE EXPRESS
5. Cleaning
All equipment should be cleaned
IMMEDIATELY after each use with
a Cleaner. Failure to follow this
procedure will result in application
equipment becoming unusable. Small pump housing repair
298
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
299
METALGRADE REBUILD
Application
Data Mixing Ratio Mixing Ratio Pot Life (mins)
Volume Weight (Working Life)
Activator Base Activator Base 5 C 10 C 15C 20 C 25 C 30 C 35 C 40 C
1 2 1 2,5 20 18 15 13 12 10 9 6
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 15 mm thickness
1,7 1,9 1,85 100 540 Excellent
Phys/Mec
Properties Compressive Strength ASTM D695 55 MPa 8000 psi
3.06 Tensile Shear Adhesion ASTM D1002 19 MPa 2800 psi
Flexural Strength ASTM D790 38 MPa 5600 psi
Corrosion Resistance ASTM B117 5000 hours
Hardness (Shore D) ASTM D2246 80
Hardness (Rockwell R) ASTM D785 100
Nuclear Decontamination BS 4247 Part 1 Excellent
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 90 C / 195 F + 80 C / 176 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed MetalGrade Rebuild can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
300
METALGRADE REBUILD
301
METALGRADE REBUILD
4. Machining
3.06 Once the MetalGrade Rebuild has Flange rebuilt
cured for the minimum time indicated
in the Curing Properties Section
of the product specification sheet,
sanding, grinding and machining etc.
can be carried out using standard
engineering practices.
5. Cleaning
All equipment should be cleaned
IMMEDIATELY after each use with
a cleaner. Failure to follow this Worn impeller shaft
302
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
303
METALGRADEHI-TEMP
With all kits comes 5 x pair of Gloves, 1 pc. Working data sheet, 1 pc. Safety Data Sheet
Identification
Pouch with metallic grey paste
Application data
Mixing ratio Pot life (mins) (working life)
Option 2)
Air dry for 57 hours then cure at 100 C (210 F) for 24 hours prior to operation.
Technical data
Specific Gravity 1,56 g/cm3
Phys /Mec
properties Coefficient of
24 hours at room temp. +
Service temperatures
Maximum temp. Minimum temp.
304
METALGRADEHI-TEMP
305
METALGRADEHI-TEMP
306
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
307
AquaGRADE REBUILD
Application
Data Mixing Ratio Mixing Ratio Pot Life (mins)
Volume Weight (Working Life)
Activator Base Activator Base 5 C 10 C 15C 20 C 25 C 30 C 35 C 40 C
1 1 1 1 45 40 35 25 25 20 20 15
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 15 mm thickness
1,55 1,7 1,6 100 625 Good
Phys/Mec
Properties Compressive Strength ASTM D412 34 MPa 5100 psi
Tensile Shear Adhesion ASTM D412 18 MPa 2600 psi
3.06 Abrasion Resistance ASTM D4060 -
Corrosion Resistance ASTM B117 > 5000 hours
Hardness (Shore D) ASTM D2246 85
Impact Resistance ASTM D256 4 kJ/m2
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 80 C / 176 F + 70 C / 158 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed AquaGrade Rebuild can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
308
AQUAGRADEREBUILD
2. Mixing
Transfer the contents of Base
and Activator containers from the
respective jars into the mixing
container provided. Mix in the raio Pipes leaking water
309
AquaGRADE REBUILD
4. Machining
Once the AquaGrade Rebuild has
cured for the minimum time indicated
in the Curing Properties Section of the
product specification sheet, sanding
and grinding can be carried out using
standard engineering practices.
5. Cleaning
All equipment should be cleaned
IMMEDIATELY after each use with
a cleaner. Failure to follow this Leaking tanks
procedure will result in application
equipment becoming unusable.
310
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
311
CERAMIGRADE REBUILD
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 10 mm thickness
1,8 1,8 1,8 100 555 Good
Phys/Mec
Properties Compressive Strength ASTM D412 84 MPa 12400 psi
Tensile Shear Adhesion ASTM D412 24 MPa 3500 psi
3.06 Abrasion Resistance ASTM D4060 0,08 cc / 100 cycles
Corrosion Resistance ASTM B117 > 5000 hours
Hardness (Shore D) ASTM D2246 80
Impact Resistance ASTM D256 3 kJ/m2
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 80 C / 176 F + 70 C / 158 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed CeramiGrade Rebuild can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
312
CERAMIGRADEREBUILD
313
CERAMIGRADE REBUILD
2. Mixing 5. Cleaning
Transfer the contents of Base All equipment should be cleaned
and Activator containers from the IMMEDIATELY after each use with
respective jars into the mixing a cleaner. Failure to follow this
container provided. Mix in the raio procedure will result in application
indicated. Lids should be replaced equipment becoming unusable.
immediately after use. The two
components should be thoroughly 6. Health and safety
mixed until completely streak free and
a uniform colour is achieved, using As long as normal good practices
the spatula provided. are observed CeramiGrade Rebuild
can be safely used. A fully detailed
Material Safety Data Sheet is
3. Application
included with the set. The information
Prepared Surfaces should be dry. provided in this Instruction sheet
Using the spatula provided the mixed is intended as a general guide
material should be spread evenly only. Users should determined the
onto the prepared area, working the suitability of the product for their
material into any cracks and surface own particular purposes by their
defect. Once the CeramiGrade own tests.
Rebuild has reached initial set the
material can be separated from
surfaces treated with release agent.
When CeramiGrade Rebuild is being
used to repair leaking pipes, the
flow through the pipe should be
discontinued until the repair is made
and the CeramiGrade Rebuild is
set. Any leaking fluid must be wiped
from the prepared surface before
undertaking the repair. When a
second coat is required, this should
Corroded tube plates
3.06 be done as soon as the first coat has
set. (within 4 hours)
4. Machining
Once the CeramiGrade Rebuild has
cured for the minimum time indicated
in the Curing Properties Section
of the product specification sheet,
sanding, grinding and machining etc.
can be carried out using standard
engineering practices.
Eroded impellers
314
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
315
CERAMIGRADE LINER
Application
Data Mixing Ratio Mixing Ratio Pot Life (mins)
Volume Weight (Working Life)
Activator Base Activator Base 5 C 10 C 15C 20 C 25 C 30 C 35 C 40 C
1 4 1 5 45 35 30 25 20 15 13 10
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 2 mm thickness
1,0 1,67 1,55 100 645 n/a
Phys/Mec
Properties Compressive Strength ASTM D412 70 MPa 10200 psi
Tensile Shear Adhesion ASTM D412 16 MPa 2300 psi
3.06 Abrasion Resistance ASTM D4060 0,09 cc / 100 cycles
Corrosion Resistance ASTM B117 5000 hours
Hardness (Shore D) ASTM D2246 80
Impact Resistance ASTM D256 5 kJ/m2
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 70 C / 158 F + 60 C / 140 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed CeramiGrade Liner can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
316
CERAMIGRADELINER
317
CERAMIGRADE LINER
3.06 4. Machining
Once the CeramiGrade Liner has
cured for the minimum time indicated
in the Curing Properties Section
of the product specification sheet,
sanding, grinding and machining etc.
can be carried out using standard
engineering practices. General wear on butterfly valve surface
5. Cleaning
All equipment should be cleaned
IMMEDIATELY after each use with
a cleaner. Failure to follow this
318
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
319
CERAMIGRADEABRASHIELD
Identification
Activator Component Base Component
Appearance Colour Appearance Colour
Paste Red Paste White
Application
Data Mixing Ratio Mixing Ratio Pot Life (mins)
Volume Weight (Working Life)
Activator Base Activator Base 5 C 10 C 15C 20 C 25 C 30 C 35 C 40 C
38 100 33 100 50 45 35 25 15 11 8 5
Phys/Mec
Properties Compressive Strength DIN 53454 8085 MPa 00000 psi
Tensile Shear Adhesion DIN 53455 > 20 MPa 0000 psi
Abrasion Resistance SABS 14491996 9095 mm3
3.06 Corrosion Resistance ASTM B117 > 5000 hours
Hardness (Shore D) DIN 53505 7881
Impact Resistance DIN 53453 2,5 kJ/m2
Flexural Strength DIN 53452 7075 MPa
Lap Shear Strength ISO 4587 5,5 MPa
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 8590 C / 000 F + 8085 C / 000 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Below - 20 C impact resistance will be considerably reduced. The product will become brittle.
Chemical resistance Excellent against water, oil, grease, detergents, diluted acids and alkaline. Resistant to solvents, aliphatic
alcohols and aromatics. Against esters, ketones and chlorinated hydrocarbons, tests are recommended.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed Ceramigrade Abrashield can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
320
CERAMIGRADEABRASHIELD
321
CERAMIGRADEABRASHIELD
3.06
Improve addition by Anchoring the product by welding Ceramigrade Abrashield can also be used in combina-
small angle irons to the surface to be coated. tion with the hard surfacing electrode Abratech-330 to
fill in between runs. The welding runs give the polymer
side support and stability.
322
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
323
RUBBERGRADE 6 REBUILD
Application
Data Mixing Ratio Mixing Ratio Pot Life (mins)
Volume Weight (Working Life)
Activator Base Activator Base 5 C 10 C 15C 20 C 25 C 30 C 35 C 40 C
- - - - 15 10 10 8 8 7 6 5
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 12 1/2 mm thickness
1,2 0,98 1,04 100 962 Excellent
Phys/Mec
Properties Tensile Strength ASTM D412 4 MPa 600 psi
Tear Strength ASTM D624 4,5 MPa 650 psi
3.06 Elongation ASTM D790 260 %
Hardness (Shore A) ASTM D2240 65
Dielectric Strength ASTM D149 -
Surface Resistivity ASTM D257 -
Volume Resistivity ASTM D257 -
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 80 C / 176 F + 70 C / 158 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed Rubbergrade 6 Rebuild can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
324
RUBBERGRADE6 REBUILD
325
RUBBERGRADE 6 REBUILD
4. Machining
Once the RubberGrade 6 Rebuild has
cured for the minimum time indicated
in the Curing Properties Section of the
product specification sheet, sanding
and grinding can be carried out using
standard engineering practices.
326
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
3.06
327
RUBBERGRADE 6 REMOULD
Application
Data Mixing Ratio Mixing Ratio Pot Life (mins)
Volume Weight (Working Life)
Activator Base Activator Base 5 C 10 C 15C 20 C 25 C 30 C 35 C 40 C
- - - - 15 10 10 8 8 7 6 5
Technical
Data Density g/cm3 Volume Solids Volume Capacity Slump Resistance
Activator Base Mixed % cc/1000gm 12 1/2 mm thickness
1,2 0,98 1,04 100 962 -
Phys/Mec
Properties Tensile Strength ASTM D412 7 MPa 1015 psi
Tear Strength ASTM D624 4,5 MPa 650 psi
3.06 Elongation ASTM D790 250 %
Hardness (Shore A) ASTM D2240 65
Dielectric Strength ASTM D149 -
Surface Resistivity ASTM D257 -
Volume Resistivity ASTM D257 -
Values are determined after 48 hours at 20 C
Service
Temperatures Dry heat Wet heat Minimum temp
+ 80 C / 176 F + 70 C / 158 F - 20 C / - 4 F
Chemical resistance Suitable for permanent immersion at 20 C (68 F) in a limited range of chemicals. For a more detailed
description refer to the Chemical Resistance Chart.
Manufactured under a quality program certified to ISO 9002
Health and Safety As long as good practice is observed Rubbergrade 6 Remould can be safely used. Wearing of rubber
gloves is advisable during use. Prior to using this product please consult the Safety Data Sheet
provided with each packaged product.
328
RUBBERGRADE6 REMOULD
329
RUBBERGRADE 6 REMOULD
3. Application
Using the spatula provided the mixed
material should be spread evenly
over the prepared area, working the
material into any cracks and surface
defects. Take care not to trap air
bubbles in deep cavities.
4. Machining
Once the RubberGrade 6 ReMould
has cured for the minimum time Hatch cover seals
indicated in the Curing Properties
Section of the product specification
sheet, sanding and grinding can
be carried out using standard
engineering practices.
5. Cleaning
All equipment should be cleaned
IMMEDIATELY after each use with
a cleaner. Failure to follow this
procedure will result in application
equipment becoming unusable.
330
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
3.06
331
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
3.06
332
ARC PROCESSES&EQUIPMENT
4.01
333
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
4.01
334
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
Basic principles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Power source characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
Selecting power source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
UWI-150 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
UWI-203TP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
UWR-320TP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
UWI-400 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
UWR-852 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
Primary extension cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
Secondary cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
Electrode holders, cable connectors &return clamp assembly . . . . . 363
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
Welding techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
Edge preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373
Electrodes for electrode welding &gouging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
Air Carbon arc gouging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
4.01
335
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Introduction
The principle of Manual Metal Arc Welding (MMAW) commonly called stick
electrode welding is, as for all arc welding processes, based on the electric
circuit. The electric arc formed between electrode and workpiece has two
objectives, to melt the edges of the joint forming a melt pool on the workpiece,
and to melt the tip of the coated electrode. The electrode is consumed and acts
as a filler material mixing with the melted base material to fill up the joint.
Initially manual metal arc welding was done with bare metal electrodes without
any coating, a process that was first introduced in 1888 in Russia.
The first coated electrode was patented by the Swedish engineer Oskar
Kjellsberg in 1905, but it took some years of refining coatings and testing the
reliability of welded joints before the process was accepted in the fabrication
of steel constructions. In 1938, however, the worlds first wholly welded
oceangoing ship was launched in Malm, thereby introducing MMA welding as
a production process for the maritime market.
The popularity of the Manual Metal Arc Welding process is to a large degree
based on its versatility in addition to its modest requirements for equipment.
Even quite unsophisticated welding machines like a step-down transformer
may be used as power supply, at least for the less demanding electrodes,
and the only welding equipment required in addition to the power supply is a
suitable electrode holder.
By selecting the correct electrode, most metallic material may be arc welded
in any position and in any thickness down to approximately 2 mm.
Different electrode holders are required depending on the type of welding
work. In this chapter the following will be described:
Normal welding/gouging with coated electrodes
Air-Carbon-Arc gouging with copper coated carbon electrodes
Each of these areas require their special electrode holder.
4.01
Arc processes require a complete electric circuit. Always remember proper connection
of the return clamp.
336
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Practical setup
Welding machine
Welding cable
Return cable
Electrode
holder
Electrode
Return clamp
Arc
Workpiece
4.01
Welding current
The arc properties are dependent on the current supplied to it. Basically there
are two different types of electric current; alternating current (AC) and direct
current (DC). DC is a stream of negatively charged electrons flowing through
the cable, moving from the negative pole (-) to the positive pole (+). AC is
achieved when the power supply switches positive and negative polarity at
a frequency which normally is 50 or 60 times per second (50 or 60 Hz). The
electrons will then no longer flow in a steady stream but flow back and forth in
the cable, and 100 or 120 times a second the current will actually be zero, as
shown in the diagram.
337
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
AC as welding current
(inverter or rectifier) that rectifies
Mains power will normally be AC, and the AC from the mains supply to a
the simplest form of welding power DC of correct amperage and voltage
sources are transformers that reduce for welding. To avoid the dangers the
the mains voltage and provide means current pulses represent in cases of
for adjusting the amperage (welding electric shock, several countries have
current), still delivering AC to the issued regulations on how smooth
welding arc. As the AC actually is the DC current shall be in order to be
zero each time it changes direction accepted as DC without requirements
only electrodes specially developed for open circuit voltage reducing
for AC will be usable with welding devices. These requirements should
transformers. be observed when installing welding
The pulsating effect of AC has proven equipment on board.
to be especially dangerous to an
operator in case of electric shock.
Where burns are the main danger
from an electric shock from DC, the
AC pulses may in addition cause
cramps and heart failure as the
pulses affect the nervous system.
Authorities in several countries have
therefore issued special regulations
and demands for open circuit voltage
reducing equipment for welding
power sources with AC output.
The only welding application that
requires AC as welding current is TIG
welding of aluminium, as the back
and forth flowing electrons serve the
purpose of tearing up the unmelted
oxide layer that forms on top of an
aluminium melt pool. However, in
onboard repair and maintenance
4.01 welding the Wire Welding Process
Gas Metal Arc Welding (GMAW)
process is an alternative for DC current, constant towards the positive
aluminium welding which offers (+) pole.
several advantages, and is done with
DC. AC current cycling from one direction
through zero to the opposite direction, 50
or 60 complete cycles per second.
DC as welding current
DC is by far the best suited and most
commonly used current for welding
processes. It is normally obtained
through a welding power source
338
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
+
70 % 30 % + 50 %
DC- DC+ AC
Direct current moving from to + Alternating current
339
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
340
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
U U = 10 + 0,04 * I
(IEC 974)
U
U = 20 + 0,04 * I
(IEC 974)
U = 14 + 0,05 * I
I
(IEC 974)
341
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWR-852 UWI-400
342
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Properties:
343
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Technical Data
Description Unit Property
Welding current range, Electrode A 20-150
Welding current range, TIG A 5-150
Open circuit voltage, max. V 69
Max. touchable sensing voltage V 16
4.01 Duty cycle at max. current % 30
Mains phases - 1
Mains phase, frequency Hz 50/60
Mains voltage V 115/230
Recommended fuses (slow) A 32/16
Protection class - IP23
Approval marks - S, CE
Weight Kg 6,2
Height x Width x Length cm 23x14x34
Open circuit voltage below 70V provides conformance with the British DOT:
CODE OF SAFE WORKING PRACTICE FOR MERCHANT SEAMEN
344
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Ordering Information:
The order numbers include:
UWI-150 Autoline welding machine
1 pce carrying strap
2 m primary cable, mounted on the welding machine
3 m welding cable with quick connector and electrode holder (627877)
3 m return cable with quick connector and return clamp (633164)
Instruction manual
UWI-150 Autoline
Application set-up for Stick Electrode welding
UWI-150 Autoline as a manual electrode welding unit
3m Welding cable with quick connectors and
electrode holder
and
3m return cable with quick connector and
return clamp are included with the UWI-150 Autoline
345
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
4.01
346
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
4.01
347
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Technical Data
Description Unit Property
Welding current range, DC A 5-200
Open circuit voltage, max V 65 325
Duty cycle at max. current % 40
Mains phases 3
Mains phase, frequency 50/60 Hz
Mains voltage V 380-440 230
Recommended fuses (slow) A 10
Protection class IP 23S
4.01 Approval marks CE
Height mm 325
Length mm 460
Width mm 230
Weight kg 12,2 460
Open circuit voltage below 70V provides conformance with the British DOT:
CODE OF SAFE WORKING PRACTICE FOR MERCHANT SEAMEN
348
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWI-203 TP
Application set-up for Stick Electrode welding
UWI-203 TP as a manual electrode welding unit
3m Welding cable with quick connectors and
electrode holder and 3m return cable with quick
connector and return clamp are included with
the UWI-203 TP.
349
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Technical Data
Description Unit Property
Welding current range, DC A 10-320
Open circuit voltage, max V 8
Duty cycle at max. current % 30
Mains phases 3
Mains phase, frequency 50/60 Hz
Mains voltage V 380-440
Recommended fuses (slow) A 16 325
4.01 Protection class IP 23S
Approval marks CE
Height mm 325
Length mm 460
Width mm 230 230 460
Weight kg 18
Open circuit voltage below 70V provides conformance with the British DOT:
CODE OF SAFE WORKING PRACTICE FOR MERCHANT SEAMEN
350
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWI-320 TP
Application set-up for Stick Electrode welding
351
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWI-400
Multi purpose welding inverter
Multi function welding machine for
Stick electrode, TIG and Wire welding.
Can be connected to any 3 phase
primary voltage between 380 V and
440 V, frequency 50-60 Hz.
Automatic shut down function against
input voltage, fluctuations outside
10% of rated voltage range.
Display information to operator on
display stating reason for shut down.
Step-less current control from
5-400 A.
Technical Data
Description Unit Property
320 Type UWI-400
Welding current range, DC A 5-400
Open circuit voltage, max. V 70
Duty cycle at max. current % 30
Mains phases 3
Mains phase, frequency Hz 50/60
400 Mains voltage V 380-440
Recommended fuses (slow) A 20
Efficiency % 85
Insulation class H
Protection class IP 23
492 Approval marks CE
Height mm 400
4.01 Length mm 492
Width mm 320
Weight kg 34,5
Ordering Information:
The order numbers include:
UWI-400
3 m primary cable.
Instruction manual.
352
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWI-400
Application set-up for Stick Electrode welding
UWI-400 as a manual electrode welding unit with a remote control unit and welding
cables.
Miscellaneous
Remote control cable extension, 25 m 191-670422
4.01
353
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWI-400
Application set-up for TIG welding
UWI-400 as TIG welding unit with a remote control unit, TIG torch set and return cable.
Argon for TIG shielding gas is available in 10 l cylinders (E-10) and 50 l cylinders (E-50).
4.01
354
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWI-400
Application set-up for Wire welding
UWI-400 as wire welding unit with a SC 12 RC wire feeder, wire welding torch and return
cable.
Argon or Argon CO2 for Wire Welding shielding gas available in 10 l cylinders (E-10/M-10)
and 50 l cylinders (E-50(M-50)
4.01
355
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
4.01
Air supply 7
356
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Important:
If parallel connection of two UWI-400
machines, both machines must be
switched on. If only one machine is
switched on the current in the parallel
cable may damage the other machine.
NB. NB.
4.01
NB In this location the remote control extension cables can be mounted
Length depends on distance from welding machine to work site and desired
work radius. The extension cable can be connected into longer lengths if
necessary.
357
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
UWR-852
Superior power for heavy duty Air Carbon Arc Gouging.
Excellent arc welding performance with Stick and
TIG welding
Built-in arc control:
lets you get in tight without sticking the electrode. An
electrode compensation circuit ensures
consistent arc control performance regardless of the
electrode size.
Hot Start: makes it easier to start difficult-to-start Stick
electrodes such as E-6010 and E-7018.
Simple control panel: features single range amperage
adjustment and provides easy, efficient operation.
Line voltage compensation: ensures consistent weld
performance by keeping output power constant even if primary input power varies by
10%.
14-pin receptacle: provides quick, direct connection to remote controls and switches.
Enclosed circuit boards: provide additional protection from contaminants resulting in
longer service life.
PC board protection: prevents the wire feeder power or other stray voltages (less than
115 VAC) from harming the power source PC board.
Thermal overload protection: helps prevent machine damage if the duty cycle is
exceeded or airflow is blocked. A warning light indicates power shutdown.
Fan-On-Demand: The fan operates only when needed, reducing noise, power
consumption and the amount of airborne contaminants pulled through the machine.
115 V receptacle: provides15 amps of auxiliary power. Power cord strain relief provided
for convenience at installation.
Technical Data
Description Unit Property
Type UWR-852
Welding current range, DC A 50-850
Welding current at 60% duty cycle A 650
Open circuit voltage, max. V 70
Ordering Information: Duty cycle at max. current % 30
The order numbers include:
Mains phases 3
UWR-852 with instruction manual.
4.01 Mains phase, frequency Hz 50/60
NOTE: Primary cable is not included.
Mains voltage V 380/440
Fixed installation is recommended on the
Recommended fuses (slow) A 90/80
primary side.
Recommended primary cable mm2 3x10+PE
Efficiency % 85
Description Unit Product no. Insulation class H
UWR-852 pcs 191-735860 Protection class IP 23
Remote Control Approval marks CE
with 8 m cable pcs 191-670414 Height incl. lifting eye mm 762
Remote Control Length mm 966
extension cable Width mm 585
25 m pcs 191-670422 Weight kg 229
358
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Primary extension cables
The Unitor power sources are delivered with a 2 or 3 meter primary cable. If
a longer primary cable is needed this is our recommendation for length and
dimension. Note that dimensioning of the cable does not only depend on cable
length but also the voltage on the mains.
Size Product no. per m.
3 x 2,5 mm2 + G 195-526335
3 x 4,0 mm2 + G 195-526343
3 x 10 mm2 + G 195-526350
UWI-150 Autoline
UWI-203TP
UWI-320TP
3+G
359
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Secondary cables
(welding and return cables)
The cross-section dimension of a welding cable must be compatible with both
the welding current which will be used and the total length of welding and
return cable which will be used in the welding circuit.
The first requirement is the maximum load the cable can carry without
overheating. The following maximum load ratings apply to neoprene insulated
welding cable at 25C ambient temperature.
As guideline, it should be noted that normal hand welding using coated stick
electrodes and TIG welding is carried out at a duty cycle (effective welding
time) of 30-40%, while wire welding and air carbon arc gouging may have a
duty cycle of up to 60%.
The maximum current values are based on the capacity of the cables alone.
However, the voltage drop in the cables will often be the decisive factor when
choosing the right cable size. The theoretical voltage drop in 100 meters copper
cable of four different cross sections is shown for increasing currents in the
following diagram:
4.01
360
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
It will be seen that the voltage drop in the different cable cross-sections
100 meters 70 mm2 cable is 6 V at 250 and the different types of welding
A DC. When using longer lengths of machines based on the following
cable, the voltage drop will increase calculation:
proportionately, i.e. on a 200 meter
length of 70 mm2 cable, the voltage Maximum allowed voltage drop for a
drop will be 12 V at the same amper welding machine is
age. It should be noted that for AC the maximum output voltage at the
current, the voltage drop can be more corresponding current
than double the value for DC current minus the conventional load voltage
due to inductive resistance, especially (IEC60974-1).
when the welding cables lie across
a steel deck. When the voltage drop The maximum length of welding
is excessive, welding characteristics cable (total length from return cable
suffer accordingly. How large a voltage and electrode holder cable) for
drop that can be tolerated will depend this voltage drop is calculated as
on the type of welding machine and followed:
type of electrode. Length < voltage drop/current
The following table shows the conductivity of copper (58) cable
theoretical cable lengths relevant to cross section
x) Bring machine to work site and use short electrode/ground cables only
Note:
By connecting two cables in parallel, the voltage drop can be halved and the
distance from machine to welding area thereby doubled.
361
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
362
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
Electrode holders, Cable connectors before fixing the return clamp so that
and return clamp assemblies sensitive machine parts such as ball
Cable connectors and return clamps bearings etc. are not used as a bridge
are important but often neglected for welding current. There are three
parts of the welding current circuit. types of return clamps available, the
The voltage drop in a poor or a 200A, 400A and 600A. All Unitor return
wrongly positioned return clamp clamps also come with 3 m cable and
can be considerable, equal to many connector.
meters of additional cable, and the
welding arc will suffer accordingly The Cable connectors
(see section on voltage drop in
welding cable). Cable connectors must be insulated
in such a way that the danger of
handling or short-circuiting through
The Electrode holders the deck is reduced to a minimum.
Unitors fully insulated electrode This applies both to connected and
holders are of the lever screw type unconnected parts. There should
and feature an especially robust be no possibility of short-circuiting
and safe clamping arrangement for in connected plugs and sockets
the electrodes. The holders are of attached to cables, even if they
strong and simple construction. There should come into occasional contact
are three types of electrode holder with salt water. There must be good
available, the 200A, 400A and 600 A. contact and little resistance at the
contact areas and at the welding
All Unitor electrode holders also cable connections to the connectors.
come complete with 3 m cable and Unitor Safety cable connectors meet
connector. these requirements, more than 1400
mm2 contact area ensuring good
The return connection contact between plug and socket,
The return connector must be and when carefully assembled, the
sufficiently dimensioned to provide connectors are as good as watertight
good contact for the welding current against spray and when decks are
load to be used. The positioning of sporadically washed. The connectors
the return clamp determines how may be used on cable dimensions
large a part of the vessel or of the from 35 mm2 up to 95 mm2 and are
designed to accept up to 750 A 4.01
work piece is to be utilized as part
of the welding current circuit. The welding current.
return clamp should always be placed Dix quick-action connectors are used
as close as possible to the welding for front panel connections on the
area, or on the work piece itself if welding machines. These provide
this is not an integral part of the hull. easy polarity changes, but are not
The thickness of material between fully insulated and are therefore not
welding point and return clamp must recommended as cable connectors.
be sufficient to carry the current load Adapters for connection to Unitor
that is to be used. Think carefully Safety connectors are available.
363
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
364
ELECTRODEWELDINGANDGOUGING
365
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Electrode holders
Electrode holder Twisty 200 Amps.
For electrode dia. 1.63.2 mm.
4.01
366
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Return clamps
Return clamp 200 Amps.
Jaw opening 70 mm.
4.01
Place return clamp in direct contact with work piece. Use of the ships hull as return con-
ductor is against regulations. Make sure to grind the connection surface free from paint
and rust before connecting the return clamp.
367
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Cable Connectors
Cable connector Dix 25 male/female
complete
230 A / 60 % Duty Cycle.
Cable size 1025 mm2
Product no. 195-632885
368
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Conversion assembly
Safety Dix 70 male, 2 pcs
70 mm2 cable 0,3 m long.
PROBLEM: SOLUTION:
DIX 25 female
DIX 70 male Adapter plug DIX 70/25
4.01
Female 70
Male 25
369
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Accessories
Chipping hammer
The chipping hammer is used for the
removal of slag after arc welding. The
hammer is of robust construction and
well balanced.
Available in mild steel and stainless
steel.
Wire brush
A wire brush is used for cleaning the
welding surfaces, removal of slag, rust
etc. The brush is available with steel
or stainless steel bristles.
When working on stainless steel, a
brush with stainless steel bristles and
a chipping hammer made of stainless
steel must always be used.
Welding gauge
Correct groove preparation and
sufficient weld deposit is required
for a successful welded joint. The
welding gauge type J provides the
possibility to measure 60, 70, 80
and 90 groove angles, for measuring
throat thickness (a-measure) up to 20
mm and reinforcement up to 10 mm.
4.01
370
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Welding Techniques
Having examined the necessary
equipment and studied the safety
precautions which must be carefully
followed, we shall now look at the
actual welding operation. Surface welded at correct current value.
Current output too high, even, but coarsely
In order to obtain a good weld we
must ensure that the following points
are correct:
- The current
- The length of the arc beaded surface.
- The angle of the electrode
- Electrode travel
Current Settings
Current output is the most important The table gives the ampere limits for the most
factor in arc welding, and this is important electrode diameters, as well as rules of
where most mistakes are made. It thumb for calculating them. The values given are
is a good rule to use slightly more only valid for unalloyed and low-alloy electrodes and
current than required rather than risk for the stated electrode lengths. For root-welding,
using too little. If the current output vertical-up and overhead welding the welder should
is insufficient, fusing with the base use the lower limit. For fillet-welding in horizontal and
material will be unsatisfactory. Slag flat positions and also for vertical-down welding, the
may become embedded in the weld, amperage is set near to the upper limit.
and other faults are likely to occur.
When current, electrode travel and Diameter 2.0 2.5 3.25 4.0 5.0 6.0
angle are correct, the molten pool
of the weld will proceed smoothly Length 250/300 350 350/450 350/450 450 450
and slag will form behind the pool. Amperage 40-80 50-100 90-150 120-200 180-270 220-360
Approximate current values are given
in the descriptions of the different
types of electrodes, and are also
shown on the electrode package Length of arc
labels.
4.01
When arc welding with electrodes, it is important that
the arc be kept as short as possible in order to avoid
Welding surface appearance at the formation of pores and to prevent slag becoming
different current values: embedded in the weld. A short arc prevents the
formation of molten slag ahead of the molten pool.
This is of particular importance when welding with
basic electrodes. The guiding rule is that the arc gap
should be equal to the diameter of the wire core of the
electrode.
Current value too low, uneven surface.
371
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Electrode angle
The electrode must be held at the
correct angle during the welding
operation. The illustration shows the
angles to be used when welding in the
horizontal welding position.
Electrode travel
Move the electrode at an even rate of
travel in the welding direction, with or
without weaving. Correct rate of travel
is important to achieve a good weld.
The illustration shows the faults that 80
can occur if the electrode is moved too Arc gap
90 equal to
quickly or too slowly in a fillet weld.
electrode
diameter
Poor fusion
Slag
Correct Incorrect
372
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Edge preparation
4.01
373
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
374
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
375
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
4.01
376
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
Air-Carbon-Arc Gouging
The air-carbon-arc process utilizes with air ducts, copper coated carbon
the arc effect to melt the metal, which graphite electrodes, a compressed air
is subsequently blown away by a source (5-7 bar), cable and air hose.
jet of compressed air. The method
is therefore also useful for cutting The power source
stainless steel and other materials,
which are difficult to cut by the oxy- In the Unitor range, model UWI-
acetylene method. The air carbon 400 is a suitable power source for
arc process leaves a clean surface, air-arc cutting having the special
free from slag, and further surface characteristic required for this
preparation is usually not necessary. process.
Two welding machines may also be
General uses include: connected together in parallel by
connecting the negative terminal
Forming welding grooves.
from both machines to ground at
Cutting and perforating.
the worksite. The cables from the
Removal of defective welds.
positive terminals are then lead to
Removing defects on cast iron and
the worksite and connected at the
removing excess metal. electrode holder. For smaller jobs
Removing welding beads and burrs
using small size carbon electrodes,
from plating. model UWR-303 may be used as
The equipment consists of a welding power source. See the description
power source suitable for air carbon of UWI-400 for details on this.
arc gouging, a special electrode holder
4.01
377
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
378
ELECTRODEWELDING ANDGOUGING
379
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
4.01
380
TIGWELDING
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
Basic principles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Shielding gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
Tungsten electrodes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
TIGtorch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
Regulator &accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
Preparing the torch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Welding parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
Welding techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Edge preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
Rods and Flux for TIGwelding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
4.01
381
TIGWELDING
Introduction
The TIG welding process is in many
cases the only practical solution
to several necessary repair jobs
on board. The most frequently
used applications are welding of
aluminium-brass (Yorcalbro), Cunifer,
and stainless, heat resistant or acid
resistant steels, but the process
may be used with good results on all
weldable materials. Among the unique
advantages of using the argon gas
protected TIG arc as heat source for
welding are
An easy-to-learn method which
may be used in all positions.
A stable, intense and well directed
heat supply which ensures deep
penetration and small heat affected
zones.
Clean, smooth welds of high quality,
UWI-400 with TIG torch T-210 and
with little need for finishing (no
10 l Argon cylinder.
slag).
382
TIGWELDING
Basic principle
Onboard applications normally require
welding current up to max 150 ampere
direct current (DC).
Tungsten electrode
The Unitor Welding Rectifiers and
inverters are well suited for TIG
welding. Remote control for welding
current should be used, as it is a Gas shield Filler rod
definite advantage to adjust current
during welding.
Tungsten Inert Gas (TIG) welding (also
called Gas Tungsten Arc Welding
GTAW) is a process that is primarily
used for high quality metals such as
stainless steel, Cunifer and York Albro.
It is also used on thin walled plates
and pipes up to 3 mm.
Heat is produced by an electric arc The TIG welding, basic principle.
that is struck between a Tungsten
electrode and the work piece. The
electrode tip is grinded to a point to
constrict the arc to a single spot on
the metal surface. The arc and the
electrode are shielded by an inert gas
(usually Argon) that also surrounds
the weld pool and prevents oxidation.
A welding rod is added to the pool to
produce a weld build-up. The welding
rod is normally made of a metal
similar to the metal being welded.
The Tungsten electrode will not melt
despite very high temperatures, but it
will be gradually be consumed during
ignition and to some extent during
actual work. This is referred to as
the burn-off rate. In time, it will be All Unitor welding machines are supplied 4.02
necessary to regrind the electrode to with characteristics especially suited for
a point. TlG.
Equipment set-up:
Gas cylinder with supply to torch.
Torch connected to negative polarity of
DC power source.
Return clamp and return cable from
workpiece to positive polarity
383
TIGWELDING
Shielding gas
Shielding gas is necessary for the
TIG process. The gas which must
be chemically inactive (inert), has
several functions in the TIG process:
To provide the atmosphere needed
for ionization, ensuring a stable arc
and suitable heat transfer.
To protect the hot tungsten
electrode against the oxidizing
effect of the air.
To protect the molten pool
against contamination and R510 regulator with flow meter in order to
oxidation from the air. adjust gas flow in l/min.
To protect the hot end of the filler
metal rod from oxidation.
To protect melt pool and electrode
during cooling after the arc is
broken.
Argon has proven to be the most
suitable gas for this purpose. It is a
colourless and odourless inert gas,
heavier than air, non-toxic and non-
flammable. It is obtained from air
which contains approximately 1%
argon.
For the TIG process, a purity of 99,95%
is commonly used.
It is necessary to adjust the gas flow
and a regulator with flow-meter is
therefore needed.
Onboard a ship it is necessary to have
4.02 a flow-meter that functions correctly
also when positioned out of vertical.
The Unitor R510 gas flow regulator for Argon is supplied in 10 or 50 litres
argon is specially designed for this 200 bar gas cylinders.
purpose and has a capacity of
032 l/min. Note that when welding
stainless steel it may also be
necessary to use backing gas to A separate gas supply (cylinder,
protect the backside of the weld from regulator and hoses) should be used
the oxidizing effect of the air. for this purpose.
384
TIGWELDING
Shielding gas
ARGON Ar For use on:
Argon is a colourless, odourless gas, Steel
slightly heavier than air. It is non- Stainless steel
toxic and non-combustible. Argon is Aluminium
an inert gas used as a shielding gas Yorcalbro
for TIG and MIG welding, primarily Cunifer
to protect the molten pool against
contaminants in the atmosphere.
Cylinder data
4.02
385
TIGWELDING
Tungsten electrodes
Thoriated TIG welding electrodes with The new electrodes offer:
2 % thorium oxide (colour code red)
Environmentally friendly-no
are currently the most widely used
radioactive constituents
electrodes worldwide. Thorium is
however a radioactive element and Can be transported, stored
as such represents a potential danger and disposed of without legal
to health and environment. Thorium restrictions
is a so-called a-emitter, but when Suitable for welding all materials
enclosed in a tungsten matrix, the
a radiation emitted externally is Better ignition performance than
negligible. The danger to the welder thorium alloyed type electrodes
arises when thorium oxide gets into Low burn off rate, longer service
the respiratory canals. life
This problem can occur during Standardised in national and
welding (vapours) as well as when international norms (ISO 6848, EN
grinding the electrode tip (grinding 26848, AWS A5.12, JlS Z3233)
dust). In the near future, more
stringent legal regulations regarding
production, use and disposal of
thoriated electrodes are expected.
It is expected that TlG-welding
electrodes containing thorium will
disappear from the market in the
foreseeable future, especially as
an environmentally friendly and
technically better solution is already
available.
Unitor tungsten electrodes is alloyed
with Lanthanum (colour code gold)
and is sold in sturdy boxes of 10 pcs.
4.02
386
TIGWELDING
x
Grinding must be done length
wise, straight towards the
point. Wrong grinding will
result in an unstable arc
and that bits of tungsten will
brake off and fall into the
weld deposit during welding.
Wrong grinding
xx x
4.02
1520
387
TIGWELDING
TIG TORCH
General description ceramic cups, which are recognized
The Unitor TIG torches are lightweight by a light brown color. Note that TIG
torches well adapted to general gas nozzles are brittle and may break
applications onboard. To ensure full if dropped or treated carelessly.
electrical insulation, the head of the A remote amperage control can be
torch is produced with a resilient, fixed on the TIG torch by velcro straps
high-temperature non-conductive in order to adjust amperage during
silicone coating. welding.
The replaceable heat-shield (3) in
front of the torch head is made from
teflon and has the combined function
of forming a gas tight seal for the
alumina nozzle (6) and of deflecting
heat from the torch head.
The torches are rated at 150A and
200A at 60% duty cycle. Cable and
gas hose are protected by a heat and
spatter resistant sheeting to ensure
long working life. The handle ensures
a secure grip and reduces heat
transfer to the welders hand. A screw
type gas valve opens fully at only 3/4
turn, switches the gas on and off.
Being gas cooled, the torches have Accessories
low weight and are easy to operate The torches are supplied complete
for repair and maintenance work for use, but the accessories kit
in all positions. Used with the short is recommended as it contains
back cap (1), the total length of the necessary spares.
head, including nozzle, is less than 10
cm, ensuring accessibility in narrow
spaces.
The torches are supplied with 4
m cable/hose package. Separate
4.02 welding cable and gas hose (8)
ensure that extensions may be easily
connected. The gas connection
fits directly onto the Unitor argon
regulator or to the standard right
hand threaded screw couplings for
gas hoses. As standard, Unitor is
supplying nozzles of aluminium oxide
(AL203), recognizable by the pink
colour. These nozzles will stand for
higher temperatures than the ordinary
388
TIGWELDING
2
Parts list and order numbers
1
8 6
4.02
Accessories kit consists of:
Short back cap 1 pcs
Heat-shield 1 pcs
389
TIGWELDING
Remote amp set up for TIG torch T-200 complete with DIX 70 (197-200000)
when used on UWI-400
This remote set up might also be used for stick electric welding
2
4.02
This remote set up might also be used for stick electrode welding.
390
TIGWELDING
Regulator &Accessories
The R510 regulator with flow meter
supply a steadly stream of shielding
gas to the torch. The flow rate in l/min
is adjusted on the regulator
391
4.02
392
TIG Equipment & Accessories for Unitor Welding Machine Range
Welding TIG Torch Remote Acces. KIT Ar. Regl. Gas hose Hose Joint Hose Clip, TIG Flow contr. Flow contr.
Machine Pr. Pcs. Control Pr. Pcs. Pr. Pcs. Pr. m Pr. Pcs. pck of 10 gloves needle meter at
Pr. Pcs. 6 pairs valve pcs. Nozzle pcs.
Pr. Pcs. Pr. Pcs.
UWI-150 A 197-150000 191-719575 197-607810 197-510010 176-576157 176-175596 401-729442 196-632794 197-597310 197-597328
TIGWELDING
393
TIGWELDING
Welding Parameters
It is necessary to decide approximate range of welding current needed for the
job at hand to select correct electrode, nozzle and gas flow setting.
The material thicknesses given in the table below for the different current
ranges are indicative. Actual current needed to form a proper molten pool will
also partly depend on the size of the workpiece, the type of joint, and the
amount of preheating used.
Material thickness
Steels and Stainless steels <1.5mm 1.5 - 2.5mm 2.5 - 4mm >4mm
Material thickness
Copper alloys <1.0mm 1.0-1.5mm 1.5-2.5mm >2.5mm
Welding current,
DC, electrode- 20-70A 50-120A 100-180A 150-250A
Gas flow,
pure argon 6 l/min 7 l/min 8 l/min 9 l/min
Electrode
point angle 35 45 60 60
Collet size,
diameter of electrode 1.6mm-1/16 1.6mm-1/16 2.4mm-3/32 2.4mm-3/32
Collet body, size
diameter of opening 1.6mm-1/16 1.6mm-1/16 2.4mm-3/32 2.4mm-3/32
Nozzle number and
diameter of opening no.6 (9mm) no.6 (9mm) no.7 (11mm) no.7 (11mm)
Tungsten
electrode size 1.6mm-1/16 1.6mm-1/16 2.4mm-3/32 2.4mm-3/32
4.02
394
TIGWELDING
Welding Techniques
Before welding starts, check that the
torch is connected to the negative
(-) polarity of a DC constant current
power source, and that sufficient gas is
available from the gas supply. Open the
argon cylinder valve and the torch valve.
If necessary, purge the gas system
before setting correct gas flow on the
regulator.
Striking the Arc Connect the equipment and purge the gas
system. Check electrode and electrode
Check that the electrode is properly stick-out.
pointed and protrudes 3-6mm
from the nozzle. Do not touch the
electrode unless the DIX connector is The lift arc function
disconnected. If current remote control
is available, adjust to low or minimum
current. 23 mm
Ensure that the gas valve is fully open,
(3/4 turn from closed). Place the gas
nozzle in a tilted angle on the ignition
location so that there is a gap of 2-3
mm between the tungsten electrode Place nozzle on location.
tip and the workpiece. Gradually tilt up
the welding torch until the tungsten
electrode tip touches the workpiece.
This will trigger the lift arc function.
Raise the torch and lift it into the normal
position- the arc ignites and increase in
intensity to the set amperage.
Note: To be absolutely certain that
contamination is avoided the arc may
be started on a copper plate placed on
Gradualy tilt up.
the workpiece, and then moved to the
beginning of the bead. 4.02
Adjust welding current to correct setting
and hold the arc steady until a molten
pool is formed.
395
TIGWELDING
Welding
TIG welding can be carried out in all
welding positions and the procedure
is largely similar to the gas welding
forehand welding technique. Vertical
welding is normally done upwards.
Keep an arc length of approximately
36mm. Note that a longer arc will
increase the heat input and a shorter
arc will reduce it, contrary to what
30
happens in gas welding. If welding
current remote control is used, the Welding with the forehand technique.
heat input may be adjusted through
the whole process by adjusting the
current. Hold the torch at an angle of
approximately 75 to the workpiece. The
arc may be used just to melt the edges
of the joint together, or additional filler
material may be used.
396
TIGWELDING
Contaminated Tungsten Electrode That air does not enter into the gas
The tungsten electrode may be hose.
contaminated through contact with the That wind or draft does not blow
molten pool or the filler metal rod. away the shielding gas.
That the argon supply is not
It will also be contaminated (by contaminated (try changing to fresh
oxidation) if the shielding gas supply is cylinder).
not opened before the arc is struck, or if
the gas is shut off before the electrode
has cooled down to below red glowing
temperature.
If there is little contamination the
electrode may be cleaned by striking
an arc against a copper plate and
letting it burn for a few seconds.
Remember gas supply.
If the electrode is heavily
contaminated the welding current
supply must be disconnected,
the electrode removed and the
contaminated part broken off. The
electrode must be reground to the
correct point and replaced in the
torch.
Clean the electrode by striking an arc
Contaminated Weld Pool against a copper plate.
397
TIGWELDING
Edge preparation
Stainless steel
60 55 54 1.6
40 37 36 1.6
55 51 50 1.6
80 75 70 1.6
105 98 95 2.4
398
TIGWELDING
Edge preparation
Copper alloys (Cunifer, Yorcalbro)
NB: When welding
Material Type of Welding Tungsten Stainless steel and
thickness joint current, electrode Cunifer, backing gas
mm Horizontal mm must be used inside
piping.
1 90100 1.6
100115 1.6
100115 1.6
2 115130 1.6
3 170200 2.4
190220 2.4
190220 2.4
In order to avoid surface oxidation, pipes of stainless steel must be purged with
inert gas sufficiently to remove all oxygen inside the pipe in the weld area. The
usual way to achieve this is to seal off a small length of the pipe on each side of
the weld groove. This restricted volume is then purged with a suitable inert gas,
sufficiently to remove all oxygen.
The ideal concentration of oxygen is below 25 ppm, as this is insufficient to
oxidize stainless steel.
The most common gas to use is Argon or Formier gas (90% N2 and 10% H2)
399
TIGWELDING
IMS-210 097-604850 Unitor IMS is a welding rod for unalloyed and low alloyed steels.
2.0 mm Rods with diameter 2.0mm are most used for TIG welding.
ICROMO-216 097-305532 lcromo is a chromium-molybdenum alloyed welding rod for heat
2.5 mm resistant steels types 10 Cr Mo-910 and 13 Mo-44 found in boiler
tubes and other heat resistant components. Gas or tensile
strength 560 Mpa.
18/8 Mo-221 097-602979 18/8 Mo is a wire for welding stainless and acid resistant steel.
2.0 mm The silisium content of the wire ensures smooth transfer and
good profile of the bead. Application areas are similar to the
coated electrode 18/8-321 Nin 1.7 mm, but with the advantages
TIG can offer. When welding very thin sheets and pipes
(less than 2mm) it is always an advantage to use the TIG process.
This is also an advantage for the root bead when welding thicker
sheets with prepared V-grooves.
IDUPLEX-222 097-725309 Iduplex-222 is at TIG rod for welding Duplex stainless steel,
2.0 mm Duplex to Mild steel and Duplex to Stainless steel. The deposit
offers elevated mechanical strength and toughness reistance
to stress corrosion cracking. It is an advantage to use TIG
welding in thin sheets and pipe walls. Can also be used for
welding the root run in thick wall piping where the rest of the
groove is filled up using the duplex electrode Duplex-325 N.
ICUNI-30-239 097-335547 A welding rod for TIG welding of copper nickel alloys, for
2.5 mm example Cunifer pipes. No flux is used in this process. Typical
applications are welding flanges on pipes, pipe joints, patching
leaking pipes etc. Joint surfaces and adjacent areas must be
thoroughly cleaned before welding. Small diameter Cunifer pipes
can be joined by means of overlap joints (capillary action) using
AG-60 silver solder combined with AG-60 Flux.
IALBRO-237 MF 097-519736 IALBRO is a flux-coated filler rod for TIG welding of aluminium-
2.4 mm brass pipes (Yorcalbro). This type of alloy is widely used in
seawater resistant piping. In TIG welding of joints it is strongly
recommended that I-Flux 238 be applied to both sides of the joint
on the inside. Yorcalbro pipes with a diameter less than 4 which
can be joined by means of an overlap joint (capillary action) may
4.02 be silver brazed using AG-60 combined with Albro Flux.
Flux
IFLUX-238 PF 097-603092 Unitor flux is supplied in paste form for use with the TIG rod
Ialbro-237 MF for welding of Yorcalbro. The flux is
complementary to the flux found in the serrations of the lalbro
TIG rod. While the flux on the rod is sufficient for the actual
welding zone, it is strongly recommended to use additional IFLUX
on both sides of the joint, especially on the inside of e.g. pipes.
This will improve bonding and penetration. Flux residues must be
washed off with water after welding. IFLUX is supplied in 250
gram tins.
400
WELDING HANDBOOKNOTES
4.02
401
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
4.02
402
WIREWELDING
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
Basic principles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
Shielding gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
UWW-161 TP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
SC 12 RC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
Regulator &accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
Application areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
Preparation for welding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
Welding technique . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 431
Edge preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
Wires for wire welding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
4.03
403
WIREWELDING
Wire feed
mechanism
Weld
Shielding gas
404
WIREWELDING
Basic principle
The process can roughly be divided
into two distinctive methods
depending on the wire being fed.
4.03
405
WIREWELDING
Spray-Arc
The spray-Arc is recognized by a
relatively intense arc between the
welding wire and the work piece.
The metal transfer is in the form of
a continuous spray of molten metal
droplets from the wire tip through the
arc to the surface of the melted pool.
Spray-arc welding
The arc is almost spatter free and
provides deep penetration in the base
material. The deposit rate is high,
and this arc type is recommended for
material thickness above 3 mm. transferred through rapid short
circuits between wire and work piece.
To obtain a spray-arc it is necessary The wire touches the work piece
to have welding current above a and the welding current increases
certain minimum value, the transition immediately, melting of a drop of filler
current. This current level depends material. As this drop is melted off the
on the shielding gas, (consisting arc is re-established, heating wire
of minimum 80% Argon or Helium), tip and base material until the wire
the alloy and the size of the welding feed speed again pushes the wire into
wire. As a guideline a 0.8 mm solid contact with the work piece.
steel wire will provide a spray arc
if the welding current is above This sequence repeats itself
approximately 150 Ampere. At continuously approximately 100 times
currents below this level the steady per second, providing a concentrated
spray will consist of gradually larger arc with low heat input to the work
droplets until a spray no longer can piece and rapidly solidifying deposit.
be maintained, and the short-arc is The short-arc method is therefore
established. excellently suited for sheet metal
welding, and also for bridging large
gaps in poorly aligned joints. The
Short Arc rapidly solidifying deposit also makes
is also called short circuit transfer. short-arc welding easy in any welding
No metal is transferred through the position.
arc with this technique, but is instead
4.03
406
WIREWELDING
407
WIREWELDING
4.03
408
WIREWELDING
409
WIREWELDING
4.03
410
WIREWELDING
Shielding gas
ARGON Ar Cylinder data
Argon is a colourless, Cylinder type: E-10 E-50
odourless gas, slightly Product No: 715-905565 715-905174
heavier than air. It is non- Application Welding Welding
toxic and non-combustible. Colour Grey Grey
Argon is an inert gas used Water capacity I 10 50
as a shielding gas for TIG Gas capacity kg 3.6 18
and MIG welding, primarily Gas capacity nM3 2.2 11
to protect the molten pool Filling pressure bar 200 200
Empty weight kg appr. 18 81
against contaminants in the Gross weight kg appr. 22 99
atmosphere. Overall length mm appr. 1000 1690
Outside diameter mm 140 230
For use on: Valve outlet connection W24,32mm x1/14 W24,32mm x1/14
Valve type Forged brass with bursting disc,
Aluminium inlet filter and positive pressure
Yorcalbro cartridge
Cunifer 1 nM3 = 1.637 kg. 1 bar = 14.5 psi 1kg = 2.2 lbs
1kg =0.611 nM3 1 M3=35.3ft3
411
WIREWELDING
Equipment
The basic elements in a complete The gas valve closes, preventing
equipment package for the Wire further gas supply.
Welding process are: The sequence of events and the time
1. Power source with amperage or delay between them is essential for
voltage control. a successful termination of the weld,
2. Welding current switch first to avoid that the wire sticks in
(contactor). the weld deposit, secondly to ensure
3. Power supply to wire feeder and gas shield of deposit and wire tip until
gas valve. sufficient cooling has been obtained.
4. Gas cylinder
Depending on the area of use the
5. Gas regulator with flow
elements of the Wire Welding
adjustment. equipment are arranged in different
6. Gas valve (solenoid).
ways, more or less suited to onboard
7. Wire spool.
use.
8. Wire feed motor with drive rolls.
9. Wire feed control. Most commonly used are constant
10. Torch cable package containing voltage power sources where all
welding current cable, gas hose, elements 1-9 are assembled in one
control circuit cables and wire unit, often even with the gas cylinder
feed tube (liner). mounted on the assembly. As the
11. Torch with contact tip for practical length of the torch cable
supplying current to the nozzle, package with wire feed liner is limited
and control switch. to 34 m (especially when welding
aluminium) these units are limited to
In a welding sequence these applications close to the machine.
elements function as follows when
the welder points the torch towards Another system is built around very
the starting point of the weld and small wire spools, incorporating
pushes the torch control switch: elements 711 in the torch, and the
other elements either in a control
Gas valve opens to supply gas.
box or in the power source. This is
Contactor closes to supply welding
a flexible system regarding distance
current from the power source to from the power source, but limits the
the torch contact tip and wire. selection of wires to mainly aluminium
Wire feed motor starts, feeding
alloys, due to the small wire spools.
wire through the torch.
The arc starts as the wire touches
the workpiece, and welding SC 12 RC Wire feeder principle
4.03 proceeds.
The most flexible system is to include
When welding is to be stopped the elements 2 - 9 except gas cylinder
welder releases the torch control regulator in a compact portable wire
switch and the following sequence of feeder unit, which has the ability to
events take place: utilize power sources with constant
Wire feed motor stops. voltage characteristic. Unitor Wire
After a brief moment the contactor Feeder SC 12 RC is based on this
opens, preventing further current principle and requires only welding
supply, and the arc is extinguished. current as power supply.
412
WIREWELDING
UWI-400
Wire feeder
UWF-SC 12 RC
4.03
413
WIREWELDING
Technical Data
Primary voltage 1 phase 230V 50-60Hz
Recommended fuse size 16A slow fuses
Maximum touchable open circuit voltage 10V
Voltage adjustment range for wire welding 10-26V
Wire speed adjustment range for wire welding 2-13m/min
Welding current range for MMA
(Stick) electrode welding 5-140A
Postflow gas adjustment range 0-3sec
Length x Width x Height 460x230x325mm
4.03 Weight (ex. Accessories) 12,2kg
325
230
460
414
WIREWELDING
Ordering Information
UWW-161 TP is supplied with:
2.5 m primary cable with plug, fitted on the welding
machine
Gas hose socket with nut and hose clamp for
connection to gas inlet
Wire welding torch with 3 m cable and connector
complete for 0.8 mm wire
Electrode holder for MMA (stick) electrode
welding with 3 m cable and Dix 25 connector
3 m return cable with Dix 25 connector and return
clamp
Adjustable carrying strap
Instruction manual
Unitor Wire Welder UWW-161 TP, Product no. 193 161161
415
WIREWELDING
416
WIREWELDING
Select polarity
Connect the TIG/MIG voltage selection cable to
the correct polarity for the selected wire, check
information on the label.
4.03
- +
417
WIREWELDING
Drive rolls
The drive rolls in the wire feed system must be selected according
to wire size and type, see table.
Each drive roll has two grooves in different siz es.
UWW-161 is delivered with the V-groove 160003.
Wire Loading
Release the spring loaded pressure arm (1) Replace the cap (7).
and swing the roll arm (2) up from the wire
Carefully detach the end of the wire from
feed drive roll (3).
the spool, cut the bent portion of wire off
Ensure that the groove size in the feeding and straighten the first 10cm.
position on the drive roll matches the wire
Thread the wire through the ingoing guide
type and size.
tube (8), over the drive roll (3), and into the
Place the wire spool in place on the wire outgoing guide tube.
spool spindle (4). Make sure that the stud
Close the idle roll arm (2) and latch the
(5) engages in the corresponding hole in
spring loaded pressure arm (1) in place.
the wire spool
The roll pressure on the wire is adjusted
Check the Friction Brake Adjustment, a
with the screw on the pressure arm nut
bolt inside the spindle (6).
above the spring. It should be sufficient to
When properly adjusted, the brake should ensure smooth feeding of the wire.
provide only enough drag to prevent
Rotate the spool counterclockwise if
overrun of the spool and excess slack in
the wire. Too much drag may result in wire required to take up extra slack in the wire.
feeding problems.
5
1 6
2
4
4.03
7
8
S
418
WIREWELDING
Application area
Aluminium wire
Solid wire steel
Wire size mm
mm
Product description
WIRE FEED DRIVE ROLLS
160003 Drive Roll V-groove 0.60.8 O X O X X O
160004 Drive roll U-groove 0.81-0 X
160005 Drive roll V-groove knurled 1.01.2 X O X O
OUTGOING WIRE GUIDE TUBE
161164 Outgoing wire guide tube Max. 2 X X X X X X
WIRE FED LINERS
590075 Non iron liner * 0.61.2 X X X X X X
613756 Steel liner ** 0.61.2 X X
CONTACT TIPS
711986 10 tips 0.6 mm 0.6 X X X X X **
711994 10 tips 0.8 mm 0.8 X X X X X **
712000 10 tips 1.0 mm 0.91.0 X X X X X **
712018 10 tips 1.01.2 mm 1.2 X X X X X X
GAS NOZZLES
160001 GAS NOZZLE 0.61.2 All wires requiring gas shielding
X = Well suited
O = May be used, but not the best solution
Contact Tip 4.03
= Not recommended, do not use
* = Non iron liner can be used for all welding wires,
but wears down quicker than steel liners Nozzle
** = Steel liner is a more wear resistant alternative Torch Neck
for black steel welding but should be avoided for
stainless and non iron wires to avoid
contamination of the weld
419
WIREWELDING
Technical Data
Type of input Power 24 Volts AC Single Phase 3.5 Amperes 50/60 HZ
Welding Power Source Type Constant Voltage CV/DC With 14 pin and
contactor control
Wire Feed Speed Range 1.3 to 17,8 mpm
Wire Diameter Range 0.6 to 2 mm (023 to 5/64 in)
Welding Circuit Rating 100 volts 500 amperes 100% Duty Cycle
IP Rating 23
Overall Dimensions Length: 508 mm, Width 203 mm, Height: 394 mm
Weight 11.6 kg (27 lb)
Description Unit Product No.
Wire Feeder SC 12 RC, ex torch pcs 193-657106
4.03
394
508
203
420
WIREWELDING
Regulator w/
flow meter
Gas cylinder
380440 V
3 Phase Power source
UWI-400
Gas hose
Power cable
SC 12 RC
Wire feeder
Return cable
Control
cable
Return clamp
Wire torch
Euro Connector
4.03
421
WIREWELDING
SC 12 RC
Drive rolls
KNURLED
For cored wire
Unitor product:
HST-SF-203 1.0 mm
HST-SF-232 1.7 mm
S 316M-GF-221 0.9 mm
S 309 M-GF-222 0.9 mm Knurled
Abratech-W-230 1.6 mm
SMOOTH V-GROOVE
For hard wire
Unitor product:
GPS-W-200 0.8 mm
Ialbro-W-237 0.8 mm
Icuni-W-239 0.8 mm Smooth
V-groove
422
WIREWELDING
Drive rolls
4.03
200 mm
55 mm
423
WIREWELDING
Gas cylinder
UWI-400
1 3
SC 12 RC
Standard
cable/hose length 3 m
4.03
424
WIREWELDING
6 5 4 2
Torch T-400 MP
The torch has adjustable neck and is delivered complete with tools for neck adjustment
and contact tip change. It is delivered with 3 m cable, complete with liner and contact
tips for 0.81.2 mm wire. The teflon liner allows for all wire types including aluminium.
425
WIREWELDING
Regulator &Accessories
The R 300 + regulator with flow meter
supply a steadly stream of shielding
gas to the torch. The flow rate in l/min
is adjusted on the regulator
426
WIREWELDING
Accessories
The multipurpose pliers provides
means for spatter removal from
the nozzle inside, tip and outside. It
has jaws for contact tip and nozzle
removal and installation, and for
cutting and pulling wire.
The Anti spatter spray prevents the
spatter from the welding arc from
sticking to the metal surface being
welded. By spraying on a thin layer
on each side of where the welding
is to take place, a barrier is formed
preventing the molten globules
from burning on to the surface.
The spatter can easily be wiped off
with a brush after welding. Time
consuming chipping and grinding is
prevented. The spray is packed in an
outer carton containing 6 X 400 ml
canisters.
4.03
427
WIREWELDING
Application areas
GMAW and FCAW processes cover Unalloyed/Iow alloyed and stainless
a wide range of applications known steels
from MMAW (coated electrodes) and Numerous gas mixtures based on
partly also the TIG process. Among Argon, Oxygen, Carbon Dioxide,
the most distinct advantages of the Helium, Hydrogen, and even traces of
processes are: other gases, have been introduced to
Welding technique is easy to learn. the market for ferrous materials, all
High quality welds. claiming their superiority for certain
High deposition rate. alloy types, welding positions, arc
No slag, or for FCAW very little slag. types etc. In onboard repair and
Unique advantages for sheet metal maintenance a stock of several gas
and aluminium welding. mixtures will be expensive and highly
impractical, and with proper selection
The last may be the most important
of filler material, not necessary.
advantage for repair and maintenance
applications, as especially aluminium Based on one shielding gas, a mixture
welding with gas or coated electrode of 75-80% Argon and 20-25% Carbon
is difficult and requires considerable Dioxide, the following applications are
experience and skill from the welder. covered:
The only other alternative, TIG, need MS type solid wire, short-arc,
special equipment and is only usable all positions, all steels weldable
on materials of limited thickness. with GPO/GPR/SPECIAL /LH/LHV
Disadvantages of the process have electrodes.
been among others heavy equipment 18/8 type flux cored wire, all
and the need for using several positions all stainless steels
different premixed shielding gases weldable with 18/8 electrodes or
for different metals and alloys. These 18/8 Mo rods.
are to a large degree being eliminated 23/14 type flux cored wire, all
by design of equipment as described positions all stainless steels
under the UWW-170 and SC 12 RC weldable with 23/14 electrodes.
principle, and by carefully selecting Flux cored wires with self-shielding
wires with or without flux core properties requiring no shielding gas
according to application area. at all are being developed to cover
an expanding range of applications,
Non-ferrous metals and will further add to the usefulness
of the GMAW/FCAW processes in
Aluminium and copper alloys are
onboard repair and maintenance.
4.03 excellently weldable both in spray- and
short-arc mode using argon as shield-
ing gas, and solid wire filler material
of Alumag, lcuni and lalbro type.
Overlap between short- and spray-arc
mode will normally be in the material
thickness range 36 mm, even though
thicker materials may be welded with
the SC 12 RC-system and short arc.
Welding is easily done in all positions.
428
WIREWELDING
429
WIREWELDING
430
WIREWELDING
Welding technique
Set the correct parameters given for cold arc and insufficient gas shield
the base material, wire and shielding and must be avoided.
gas that are to be used. These Too short stickout may overheat the
parameters include contact tip and will also allow more
(1) Gas flow rate spatter to reach the nozzle. This may
(2) Wire feed speed again cause turbulence in the gas
(3) Amperage or voltage setting flow, and insufficient shielding. When
Flux Cored Arc Welding Self Shielded
When setting the gas flow rate, allow
is to be used, a to short a stick out will
the gas to flow for a while to ensure
give porosity.
that the gas supply system is fully
purged. If in doubt of the actual wire Within limits, and depending on the
feed speed at a certain setting on characteristic of the power source,
the machine, this may be checked the welder may use the stick out to
by pressing the torch micro-switch adjust the welding parameters while
and initiate wire feed for exactly 6 welding. Increasing stick out will
seconds. Measure the wire length decrease penetration
that has been fed, multiply by 10 and increase deposition rate
you will have feed rate per minute. increase bead size
When doing this remember to keep decrease bead width.
the wire away from contact with deck Travel speed and direction
or workpiece. While feeding in this
way the wire will be electrically live
and an arc will occur if contact is
made.
While welding the welder controls
five variables; wire stickout (4), travel
speed and direction (5), torch angles
(6) and weaving (7).
Wire stickout
The stick-out is the distance from
the end of the contact tip to the
baseplate, including the arc length.
This distance decides how long the
current carrying part of the welding
wire is to be. The electric resistance 4.03
and voltage drop in the wire increases
with increasing stickout. This voltage
drop is part of what the equipment
measures as arc voltage, and the
welding current will decrease with
increasing stickout and vice versa.
Too long stickout may result in too
431
WIREWELDING
Torch angles
Torch angles may be defined as
longitudinal angle - the angle
between torch and workpiece along
the weld, and transverse angle - the
angle between torch and workpiece
sideways from the weld.
The longitudinal angle will affect
the penetration and bead form. Too
4.03 small angle should be avoided as
the shielding gas flow may drag air
in between torch and workpiece,
contaminating the weld. Torch angles
For horizontal welding an angle
between 70-80 is frequently used.
Transverse angle will normally be
432
WIREWELDING
433
WIREWELDING
Edge preparation
Steel, Position welding, 80% Ar, 20% CO2 Shielding gas
Material Type of Welding Gas Wire Welding parameters Number
thickness joint position consumption diameter Amp Volt Wire speed of
mm l/min. mm cm/min layers
0.9 55 16 290 1
1.2 65 17 340 1
Horizontal
1.6 & 6-10 0,8 80 17 420 1
Vertical
down.
1.6 85 17-18 440 1
2.0 95 18 500 1
434
WIREWELDING
Edge preparation
Stainless steel, Position welding, 80% Ar, 20% CO2 Shielding gas
Material Type of Gas Wire Welding parameters Welding Number
thickness joint consumption diameter Amp Volt wire speed speed of
mm l/min. mm cm/min. cm/min layers
1.6 85 15 460 45 1
1.6 85 15 460 50 1
2 90 15 480 30 1
Stainless steel, Horizontal welding, 80% Ar, 20% CO2 Shielding gas
Material Type of Gas Wire Welding parameters Number
thickness joint consumption diameter of
Amp wire speed
mm l/min. mm cm/min. layers
60
6.5 (1/4) 1,5 18 1.6 250-300 380-490 2
60
9.5 (3/8) 1,5 20 1.6 275-325 460-570 2
60
12.7 (1/2) 1,5 20 2.4 300-350 190-215 3-4
4.03
90
19 (3/4) 1,5 20 2.4 350-375 215-235 5-6
90
25.4 (1) 1,5 20 2.4 350-375 215-235 7-8
435
WIREWELDING
Edge preparation
Aluminium, Horizontal welding, Argon Shielding gas
Material Type of Gas Wire Welding parameters Welding
thickness joint consumption diameter Amp Volt Wire speed speed
mm l/min. mm cm/min cm/min
1 15 1.0 40 15 600 50
436
WIREWELDING
Edge preparation
Aluminium, Position welding, Argon Shielding gas
Material Type of Welding Gas Wire Welding Welding Number
thickness joint position consumption diameter parameters speed of
mm * l/min. mm Amp Volt cm/min layers
4 mm (1/16)
90
9.5 (3/8) 5 mm 15-20 2.4 500 27 380
90
12.7 (1/2) 5 mm 15-20 2.4 540 27 420
437
WIREWELDING
4.03
438
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
4.03
439
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
4.03
440
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443
Basic principles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
Plasma cutting equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446
UPC-1041 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
Cutting technique . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450
Maintenance and trouble shooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
4.04
441
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
4.04
442
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
Introduction
In flame cutting, the cutting torch with catches fire and burns to become a
its high flame temperature of 3100 slag). The stream of oxygen, at high
C (5612F) is used to heat the steel pressure, also assists in removing
to its kindling temperature (ignition the material from the cut. Steel melts
temperature) and then by introducing at 1535C (2795F) but can be ignited
a stream of pure oxygen, to create a at 884C (1623F). This process is
rapid oxidation of the steel (the steel referred to as a chemical process
Cutting direction
Heating to
Cutting nozzle kindling tempe
rature. Jet of
Pre-heating flame pure oxygen
Stream of pure O2 leads to rapid
oxidation and
removal of slag.
Base material
443
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
Non-ferrous metals such as aluminum of matter as solid, liquid, and gas. For
and copper also have refractory most commonly known element, water
oxides coverings, which prohibit these three states are ice, water and
normal flame cutting. In addition they steam. The significant difference
also have high thermal conductivity. between these states relate to the
energy level. If we add energy in the
Stainless steel cannot be flame
form of heat to ice, the ice melts and
cut with standard flame cutting
the result is water, a liquid. If we add
equipment and technique because of
more energy to water, it vaporizes
the refractory chromium oxide formed
to the gas we normally call steam.
on the surface.
By adding even more energy to the
So how can we overcome these steam the gas become ionized. This
natures physical laws for a process ionization process causes the gas to
to work on a given metal? Simply become electrically conductive. This
by changing process from chemical electrically conductive ionized gas is
(Flame cutting) to an electric (Plasma called plasma.
cutting).
(At a temperature of between 2000C
In Plasma cutting only one condition (3600F) and 10000C (18000F) a
must apply in order to perform cutting: process of ionization and dissociation
1) The metal must be electrically of the gas molecules take place. The
conductive. molecules are split in molecular and
atomic ions and free electrons. When
this happens, the gas, which has
What is Plasma?
now become plasma, is electrtrically
One common description of plasma conductive because free electrons
is that it is the fourth state of matter. are available to carry current).
We normally think of the three states
The process utilizes the electrically
4.04
444
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
Basic principles
conductive gas to transfer energy and the high velocity of flow of free
from an electrical power source electrons and ionized particles called
trough a plasma-cutting torch to the the plasma jet is constricted to a very
material being cut. small cross section with high-energy
concentration. In the impact zone
Inside the plasma torch the arc
the high inherent energy of the jet,
is struck between the cathode
consisting of heat, ionization energy
(electrode - polarity) and an anode
and dissociation energy is released,
(tip + polarity) As compressed air
creating temperatures up to 28000C
is introduced in the arc, plasma is
(50000F). The high velocity air plasma
produced and forced out trough the
jet will efficiently melt and blow away
tip with high kinetic velocity, forming
practically any electrically conductive
what is referred to as the pilot arc.
material, and provide a narrow
Upon impact with the positive pole of
smooth cut.
the work piece the arc is transferred
from electrode / tip to electrode work The basic plasma cutting equipment
piece following the plasma gas. Due consists of a constant current DC
to the design of the torch tip this arc
4.04
445
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
4.04
Return cable
Return clamp
Cutting torch
Plasma cutting system
446
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
4.04
447
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
4.04
448
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
449
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
Cutting technique
4.04
The plasma arc goes out immediately. Air will
continue to flow for about 30 seconds. When
removing the finger from the trigger, the trigger
protection will close over the button.
450
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
451
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
452
PLASMACUTTING ANDGOUGING
In order to ensure oil and water free air for plasma cutting, Unitor recommend
the following set up:
Air line unit
w/Filter/Regulator/Lubricator
401 624585
Quick coupling
Socket 400SH
Air with oil mist
405 191700
Quick coupling
Socket 20SM
(1/4" threads)
405 191726
Mount 2/teflon Quick coupling
tape Plug 20 PH
405 191825
4.04
453
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
4.04
454
CURRENTDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
4.05
455
CURRENTDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
456
CURRENTDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
457
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
4.05
458
PROCESS&EQUIPMENT
5.01
459
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
5.01
460
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
The Combination Torch UCT-500 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464
UCT-500 Components and spares . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 466
The Unitor Workshop Cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
Welding and grinding goggles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
Portable gas equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Gas hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
Hose connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478
Gas regulators for cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480
Flashback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482
Flashback arrestors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
The acetylene/oxygen flame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
Operating instructions for UCT-500 cutting torch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486
Cutting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 488
Common cutting faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 490
Operating instructions for UCT-500 brazing, welding &heating torch 492
Maintenance of blowpipes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
Heating techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
Flame straightening techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
Welding techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
Butt joints for gas welding of steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502
Consumables and parameters for gas welding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
Soldering and brazing techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504
Edge preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506
Consumables and parameters for brazing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508
5.01
461
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Introduction
The Acetylene/Oxygen flame is an temperature of 3100 C, compared to
efficient heat source which has been e.g. propane 2800 C.
used for welding and related thermal This temperature difference, which
processes since the early 1900s. in itself is not impressive, is one
Acetylene is the fuel gas burning with reason for the high efficiency of the
the highest temperature, maximum acetylene flame. At temperatures
approximately 3160 C when mixed around 3000 C a relatively high
with oxygen (ratio 1 part acetylene to degree of dissociation of hydrogen
1.5 parts oxygen). molecules takes place in the flame
Even the neutral flame used for core. The molecules are split in
welding (mix ration 1:1.1) has a free atoms, thereby storing energy.
This stored energy is transfered
through the flame and released
immediately when the free atoms
hit the workpiece and recombine to
molecules. The total energy release
from the acetylene/oxygen flame
is therefore comparable to the
energy from a theoretical flame with
temperature 4500 C.
The energy (kJ/cm2 S) from the core flame Hydrogen molecules dissociate on the
of acetylene compared to propane at surface of the core flame and recombine
various mixing rates with oxygen. on the surface of the workpiece.
5.01
462
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Safety:
Acetylene specific gravity is 0,9 so it
is lighter than air.
Propane specific gravity is 1,5 so it is
heavyer than air.
This is an important safety factor to
consider when working onboard a
ship.
Combustion velocity of acetylene com-
pared to propane.
5.01
463
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
464
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
5.01
UCT-500 Compact kit in heavy duty PVC case,
Product number:170-500001
465
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Shank
Product No.
1)2) Shank complete w/ sockets and
non-return valves 170-174656
Welding attachments
Size* Material thickness mm Product No.
1) 0-A 40 <0,5 170-174565
1)2) 0-A 80 0.5-1.0 170-174573
1)2) 0-A 230 2-3 170-174581
1) 0-A 400 3-5 170-174599
1)2) 0-A 650 5-7 170-174607
1) 0-A 1000 7-10 170-174615
1) 0-A 1250 9-14 170-174623
Flexible welding attachments
These attachments can be bent to any desired shape.
Size* Material thickness mm Product No.
0-A160 1-2 170-183780
0-A315 2-4 170-183798
0-A500 4-6 170-183806
Singleflame heating attachments
Size* Product No.
0-A 1800 170-174631
0-A 2500 170-234864
0-A 5000 170-183756
Multiflame heating attachments
Size* Product No.
0-A1000 170-603415
0-A2500 170-603407
0-A5000 170-603399
* The size indicates consumption of oxygen in nl/ h. Acetylene
consumption is approx. 10% lower. Material thickness refers
5.01 to mild steel.
466
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Cutting attachments
Product no.:
Cutting attachments 75 Head Angle 170-174664
1)2) Cutting attachments 90 Head Angle 170-234807
Cutting attachments 0 Head Angle 170-234815
Cutting nozzles- general use
Material
Nozzle thickness Gas consumption
type mm OX nl/h Ac nl/h Product no.
1)2) 302 No. 2 3-10 1300 460 170-174698
1)2) 302 No. 3 10-25 2150 520 170-174706
1) 302 No. 4 25-50 5650 690 170-174714
1) 302 No. 5 50-100 7800 810 170-174722
Cutting nozzles for difficult access, 165 mm length
Nozzle Material Gas consumption
length mm thickness mm OX nl/h Ac nl/h Product no.
153 35-40 6000 450 170-183863
140 40-75 7000 800 170-183855
Gouging nozzle with stellite tip
Furrow dimensions Gas consumption
Width mm Depth mm OX nl/h Ac nl/h Product no.
8-11 6-11 11500 1750 170-174730
Cutting guides
Product no.
1) Roller guide 045 nozzle angle 170-174672
1) Circular motion bar complete, 84960 mm
holde diam. for use with roller guide 170-174680
Tools
Product no.
1)2) Spanner for UCT-500 170-174649
1)2) Cleaning needles for UCT-500 nozzles 176-175356
Spares for UCT-500
Product no.
Socket/ Non-return valve for shank AC, 6 mm 170-597336
Socket/ Non-return valve for shank OX, 6 mm 170-597344
Socket/ Non-return valve for shank AC, 9 mm 170-651265
Socket/ Non-return valve for shank OX, 9 mm 170-651257
Flashback arrestor set FR-20AC+OX, for UCT-500 shank 170-619270
Lubricant for O-rings 170-234997
SPARE PART KIT COMPLETE1) 170-500100
Containing 1 of each item below:
Oxygen valve assembly (blue) 170-174789
Acetylene valve assembly (red) 170-613762
0-ring set for welding/cutting attachments 170-535005
Coupling nut welding/cutting attachments 170-174771
Coupling screw for cutting nozzles 170-174813 5.01
Clamp sleeve for roller guide n.a
Sleeve for circular motion in roller guide n.a
467
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
468
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
5.01
469
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Product no.
Welding and grinding goggles
w/flip-up front frame 176-175273
470
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Accessories
Heat Resistant Mitten
Special mitten with woven kevlar
outer layer and ample insulation
against heat in the inner layers.lt
should always be kept by acetylene
cylinders and outlets to make it
possible to close the valve in case
of fire. Also suitable for handling hot
workpieces. May be used on either
right or left hand.
Product no.
Heat resistant mitten 176-233148
Miscellaneous
Welders chalk is used to mark out
positions when gas and plasma
cutting on metals. The chalk is flat
and can easily be kept in pocekts and
tool boxes.
Temperature sticks are a wax that
Product no.
melts at a preset temperature.
Simply select a stick with the desired Welders chalk, flat 196-632968
temperature and make a mark on the 5x13x127 144 pcs/pack 5.01
surface to be heated. When the stick Temperature indicator kit, 196-633081
mark goes from solid to liquid the 200/400/600/800C
temperature have been reached Galvanizing spray 196-633156
471
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
5.01
472
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
473
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
474
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Gas Hoses
UNITORs hoses for Acetylene and for welding gases. Blow new hoses
Oxygen are specially made for use with clean internally before connecting to
welding and cutting equipment. The blowpipes. Nitrogen or another inert
hoses comply with the International gas should be preferred to blow through
norm ISO 3821 specifications for Acetylene and Oxygen hoses. Never use
welding hose: compressed air, which may contain oil.
Requirements: Keep hoses away from strong heat and
extreme cold, oil and grease, chemicals,
Maximum working pressure 20 bar and from slag and sparks from electric
Test pressure 40 bar welding, gas welding or Oxygen cutting.
Minimum bursting pressure 60 bar Avoid undue stretching and kinking
of hoses. Hanging hoses must be
Oxygen hoses are colour-coded blue. supported at suitable intervals.
Acetylene hoses are colour-coded red.
Unitors product range comprises the When gas hoses are not in use they
following hose dimensions: must be coiled and hung up so as to
avoid, as far as possible, the entry of
NB: Gas hoses are measured on their damp or dirt.
internal diameter.
Description Product no. Faulty hoses
Twin gas hoses, 6mm (1/4) Inspect hoses at regular intervals.
blue/red AC + OX/m 176-526434 Hoses of doubtful quality or condition
Twin gas hoses, 9,0 mm (3/8) should be scrapped.
blue/red AC + OX/m 176-624312
Gas hose, red 6,3 mm (1/4) Do not use hoses that have been
Acetylene/m 176-175554 damaged by flashback or hose fires.
Gas hose, blue 6,3 mm (1/4) Check that the rubber is supple and
Oxygen/m 176-175562 without cracks (do this by bending the
Gas hose, red 9,0 mm (3/8) hose).
Acetylene/m 176-175539 Check the hoses for leakage by dipping
Gas hose, blue 9,0 mm (3/8) them in water while they are under
Oxygen/m 176-175547 normal pressure. Hoses must never
Gas hose, black 6,3 mm (1/4) be repaired by patching. Repair a leak
Argon/m 176-576157 immediately by cutting off the damaged
6 mm (1/4), hose is adequate for the part.
gas consumption for all blowpipes The drum for gas hoses takes up to
and cutting nozzles in the welding and approximately 100 m. of twin hose and
cutting set UCT-500. is fitted with brackets for bulkhead
Normal hose lengths are 5 or 10 meters. mounting.
If long hoses or equipment requiring Description Product no.
greater gas flows than 8.000 nI/h
(normal liters per hour) are used, 9 mm Drum for gas hose 195-175729
(3/8) hoses are recommended. For
medium and large gas consumption
the supply pressure must be increased
when longer hoses and/or smaller hose
diameters are used. 5.01
Do not use gas hoses for other
purposes, e.g. for compressed air or
propane, and do not use air hoses
475
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
650
increased efficiency.
A workshop floor free from hoses
reduces tripping accidents, improves
access for carts and trolleys and
allows for easier cleaning. 620
The Unitor Self-Retaining hose reel 220
are of robust construction, it is easy
to installed, and have a well proven
design that vouches for safe and
maintenance free usage
Single-layer retraction of the hose
Open design for safety and easy
service
All steel construction
Technical data
Hose dimensions
Max working Net weight
Medium pressure Hose size Length Including hose Product no.
Mpa (psi) mm m Kg
Oxygen/ 2.0 (290) 2X6,3 20 30 176-725260
5.01 Acetylene
476
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
5.01
477
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Hose connectors
Hose connectors have loose hose Right-hand threads
nipples for 9 mm (3/8) and 6 mm
(1/4) welding hose. The connecting Left-hand threads
nuts on the Oxygen couplings are Connecting nut, right-hand threads
right-hand threaded. The Acetylene
couplings are left-hand threaded and Connecting nut, left-hand threads
the connecting nut has an indentation Hose nipple, 9,0 mm (3/8)
in the corners of the hexagon for easy
identification. This is international Hose nipple, 6,3 mm (1/4)
practice, and gives the operator extra
protection by reducing the possibility
of interchanging hoses.
hoses never use metal
Hose connectors are used where long tubing.
lengths of hose are needed. Screw
There are also snap-couplings for
the couplings together into a gastight
quick connection of hoses and
joint (check with soapy water). It is
regulators, or outlet stations, or to
not necessary to use force. Gentle
join lengths of hose. Such snap-
tightening spares the sealing surfaces
couplings must be specially made
and should give a perfectly gastight
for use with Oxygen and Acetylene,
connection.
and so designed that the interchange
Always use the correct hose of Acetylene and Oxygen hose is
couplings to connect the welding impossible.
478
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
5.01
479
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
480
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Connection Operation
1. Never use a regulator for gases 1. Make sure that the regulator is
or pressures for which it was not closed by turning the regulating
designed. Before connecting up, screw so far out that it runs freely
make sure that the outlet union on its threads.
on the cylinder valve and the 2. Open the cylinder valve slowly until
connector of the regulator fit each the contents pressure gauge shows
other. Never force a connection the cylinder pressure (the working
that does not fit. pressure gauge should not move).
2. Before connecting the regulator to Then open the cylinder valve fully.
the gas cylinder, blow the cylinder 3. Set the desired working pressure
valve clean by opening it for a by turning the regulating screw
moment. Do not stand in front of the inwards until the correct working
outlet or hold your hand in front of pressure can be read on the
it whilst blowing it clean. Valves of working pressure gauge. For
cylinders containing flammable gases correct pressure see the operating
must never be blown clean if there is instructions for the torch you are
any risk of ignition of the gas. using.
3. Check the inlet union gasket and 4. During interruptions, or when
replace it if it is damaged. Make finishing work, close the cylinder
sure to use original gaskets and not valve. Relieve the pressures on the
home made ones, which may be a regulator until both gauges show
source of danger. zero.
4. Screw the regulator to the cylinder 5. Shut the regulator by turning the
valve. Use a thick spanner to avoid regulating screw outwards until it
damaging the connection nut. runs freely on its threads.
5. Between an Acetylene or Oxygen
regulator and the hoses in use a
flashback arrestor should always
be installed.
NOTE:
Regulators and other equipment for Oxygen must never be lubricated with
ordinary oil or grease, as this brings the risk of explosion. Use only the lubricants
prescribed by the manufacturer. If a pressure gauge does not register zero when
the pressure is released, or it has other defects, it must be replaced.
Check all connections for leakage by covering with soapy water or the like.
As a rule, such leaks can be stopped by carefully tightening the screwed
connection at the point in question. If not, the seal or the complete part must
be replaced.
Apart from replacing damaged or faulty gauges, repairs should never be
attempted on gas regulators. Faulty, old or corroded regulators should be
replaced. Internal seals and membranes will deteriorate with time, and as a 5.01
rule gas regulators should be replaced with maximum 5 years intervals. This
also applies to flashback arrestors.
481
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Flashback
Flashback is a phenomenon that 3) Flashback implies that the flame
may occur when, for some reason burns back through the torch and into
or other, the speed of combustion at the gas supply system, i.e. the hoses
one or more places in the flame hole and in the worst cases even the
becomes greater than the speed of regulators. If a flashback reaches an
gas flow, allowing the flame to burn Acetylene cylinder, which lacks the
back into the blowpipe. The degree of necessary safety equipment a serious
safety against flashback in a blowpipe accident can occur. Flashback is
depends on its design. mostly caused by reverse flow, e.g.
flow of oxygen into the Acetylene
hose, so that an explosive mixture is
Various types of flashback: present in the hose. This mixture can
1) A Backfire implies that the flame burns back into then be ignited by a backfire, which
the torch with a sharp bang. Either the flame is occurs when the torch is lit. The hose
extinguished, or it is reignited at the nozzle opening. A will then explode.
backfire is fairly harmless in itself, but it can be a sign
Handling of blowpipes in the event of
of some fault in the equipment or gas supply.
flashback:
2) In a Sustained Backfire the flame bums back into
the torch with continued burning in the mixer, often In the event of sustained backfire the
at the mixing point itself. A sustained backfire is oxygen valve of the blowpipe must be
characterised by an initial bang (backfire) followed by shut first, then the Acetylene valve.
a whistling or screeching sound from the continued Shut them as quickly as possible.
combustion. If the sustained backfire is not quickly Sustained backfire is the result
interrupted, melting will occur in the torch, and of incorrect handling and/or poor
escaping combustion products can cause injuries. maintenance of the blow pipe. Before
re-lighting after a sustained backfire
the blowpipe must be cooled. Under
no circumstances should welding or
cutting be continued before both the
equipment and the handling routines
have been checked thoroughly.
A full fashback occurs only from very
faulty handling, bad maintenance
of the blowpipe or by wrongly set
working pressure.
A backfire (popping) can easily occur
if the flamehole is dirty or damaged
see separate chapter on
maintenance of blowpipes.
To protect against a full flashback and
the dangers this entails, the welding
5.01
equipment should be fitted with
Flashback can result in the hose exploding, and/or catch- flashback arrestors and non-return
ing fire. In extreme cases, the regulator may catch fire. valves.
482
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Flashback Arrestors
Flashback Arrestors Type W-66S and Indicator lever showing that the
S-55 pressure activated cut-off has been
Maritime authorities, such as the activated. The lever is also used for
Norwegian Maritime Directorate, resetting the flashback arrestor.
require the installation of flashback (W-66 only)
arrestors for acetylene and oxygen, Indicator ring showing that the
as incorrect maintenance or use of pressure activated cutt-off has been
gas welding equipment may cause activated. The ring is also used for
flashbacks of various types.Normally resetting the flashback arrestor
these will stop in a well designed (S55 only)
torch, and are only noticed as a
Full instructions for use are supplied
popping sound in the torch. However,
with the units.
faulty handling, maintenance or
gas pressure setting may lead to a
penetrating flashback. This means Capacity At inlet
that the gas flame passes back Description (M3/hour) pressure (bar) Product no.
through the hose(s). In some cases
W-66S f/Acetylene 19 1,5 171 183970
it may also pass the regulator and W-66S f/Oxygen 110 10 171 302976
ultimately reach the cylinder. The S55 f/Acetylene 8,5 1,5 171 708537
flashback arrestors supplied by Unitor S55 f/Oxygen 50 10 171 708545
are designed for use both with gas
cylinders and gas outlet stations and
incorporate several safety functions:
Non-return valve preventing reverse
flow of gases, thereby preventing a
gas mixture from reaching pipelines
or cylinders.
Flame filter to quench the flame front
of a flashback or a burnback.
Temperature activated cut-off to
prevent further gas supply in case
of fire (activated if the temperature
rises to approx. 100C).
Pressure activated cut-off to prevent
further gas supply after a flashback
(activated by the pressure shock in
front of the flashback).
Pressure relief valve to vent off
excessive pressure in case of
flashback or wrongly set working
pressure (on W-66S only).
5.01
483
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
484
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
485
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
486
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
5.01
487
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Cutting Procedure
Oxygen cutting is a process in which
mild steel burns (oxidizes) in oxygen.
It is not a melting process. The work-
piece is heated up to approximately
900 C, after which oxygen is
applied, which burns (cuts) mild steel.
When cutting, it is important to move
the cutting torch nozzle evenly. This is
most easily done, by starting the cut as
far away from you as practicable. Then
bring the cutting torch towards you.
488
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Cutting guide
In order to ensure smooth cutting in steel plate the guide for UCT-500 should be
used. In this guide the torch may be used in any angle between 90 and 45 to
the surface. By using the sleeve for free
movement of the nozzle in the guide and
attaching the circular motion bar with
center tip complete circles with radius
42 to 480 mm may be cut.
5.01
489
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
490
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
5.01
491
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
492
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Select the correct blowpipe to suit the working pressure, open the torch
thickness and size of material to be needle valve so that the gas can flow
welded. Adjust the working pressure freely during adjustment.
for one gas at a time. To adjust the
5.01
493
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Maintenance of Blowpipes
Clean the flame and cutting oxygen
holes with Unitor cleaning drills.
These should run freely in the holes.
Do not twist them, just stick them
straight in and pull them out.
Never use steel wire, reamers or
spiral drills for cleaning. These can
ruin the smooth surfaces of the hole.
It is very important that the small
holes in the sealing end of the cutting
nozzles should not be enlarged in any
way.
Torches and cutting nozzles may be
carefully cleaned externally by means
of a soft brass brush. Do not use a
steel brush.
494
WELDING HANDBOOK NOTES
5.01
495
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Heating Techniques
The Acetylene/Oxygen flame Beside purely mechanical methods,
is frequently used for heating straightening is largely performed
workpieces onboard, whether it is for with a welding flame. This is a
preheating/postheating in combination convenient method, normally
with welding processes or for demanding no other equipment than
heating steel for bending or forming. ordinary gas welding equipment.
A normal welding flame or a normal However, you need a good knowledge
flame from special multiflame heating of how the work reacts to heating and
attachments may be used. No special cooling, and how the shrinkage forces
techniques are required except the should be exploited in straightening.
need to be careful not to overheat and In flame straightening, the
weaken parts. There is, however, one temperature should not exceed 550
area of heating that needs special 600 C. The work should be allowed to
know-how, the straightening of steel cool slowly, especially in the case of
constructions. high tensile steel.
The steadily growing use of welding Also, heat should not be applied to a
calls for an economical method spot that has been heated previously,
of dealing with the deformations, as this can cause deterioration.
which often arise in welded steel
constructions.
When heat is applied as shown in the sketch, the heated part has a tendency to
expand. As longitudinal expansion is prevented by the surrounding cold metal, a
convexity is created in the heated part.
On cooling, the heated metal contracts, with the result that the end of the
section moves upwards.
Section bars are normally straightenened with the help of heating wedges, as
5.01 shown above. On the next page we will give some guidelines on how to apply
these heating wedges.
496
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
5.01
497
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
498
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Welding Techniques
After lighting the torch, adjust the In gas welding, the joined edges of
flame until it has the characteristics the workpiece melt and fuse, with or
required for the operation to be without filler material.
undertaken. Welding can be either leftward og
A normal flame is used for welding all rightward technique. The direction
types of steel, and copper. of weld is selected according to the
thickness of the material. Rightward
A flame with a slight surplus of
welding requires more expertise,
Acetylene is used for welding
and welders with limited experience
Aluminium.
are therefore recommended to use
A flame with an excess of Oxygen leftward welding, which is the simpler
is used for welding cast iron, brass, method. In either case, make sure
bronze and zinc alloys, and for that the weld penetrates completely
brazing. and evenly on the reverse side of the
It is important to adjust welding material with no imperfections.
flame correctly for the material to be NB. Correct alignment of the
welded. Flame types are given under workpieces is essential to a good
the descriptions of the various filler joint.
materials.
5.01
499
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Leftward welding
When the filler rod is held in front of
the torch in the welding direction,
this is called leftward welding. The
welding flame points away from the
finished weld. Leftward welding is
used for sheet thicknesses up to 34
mm and for thinwalled pipes. When
welding cast iron and non-ferrous
metals, such as aluminium and
brass, always weld leftward. Brazing
should also be performed using this
technique.
Horizontal leftward welding
Adjust the equipment for the correct
flame. Move the torch with a slight
rotational movement to melt both
edges of the workpiece. Do not
hold the torch too far away from
the workpiece. (The core of the
flame should be 2-3 mm from the
workpiece). When the material begins
to melt, feed the filler rod into the
weld pool with small movements,
and welding is in process. Make sure
to find the right speed. The metal
Vertical leftward welding on each side of the seam must melt
Sheet steel up to 2.5 mm thick can be before the filler rod is fed into the
welded by vertical leftward welding. weld pool.
Weld in the same manner as for
horizontal welding.
500
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
501
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
23 mm
1.52 mm
Up to 1.5 mm
12 mm
60
Over 3 mm
Up to 2 mm
01 mm 12 mm
Close square butt joint Single V-butt joint w/feather edge
5.01
502
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Neutral
ALUMAG-235
Description
Gas welding rod for wrought and cast aluminium alloys containing up to 5 %
Mg. Generally it can be used for all cast alloys containing magnesium as the
main alloying element.
Slight
acetylene
surplus
5.01
Detailed information on these consumables to be found under the section
Consumables.
503
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
504
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
505
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Edge preparation
Capillary brazing
Capillary brazing requires a filler
material, which melts to a thin
flowing liquid with excellent wetting
properties, and a joint with parallel
surfaces. The opening between the
surfaces should preferably be 0,05
- 0,1 mm to obtain sufficient strength
and capillary effect. This effect is Joint types
based on the surface tension of the
liquid filler metal, which will pull the
filler in between the surfaces.
Where possible the surfaces should
overlap 35 times the wall thickness
of the thinner part.
Heating should be done with a neutral
or slightly reducing flame, which
will give assistance to the flux in
removing oxides from the surface.
Heat the entire area of the joint
uniformly. Starting with the thicker Maximum capillary gap between joint
part to ensure that both surfaces Surface 0.1 mm.
reach correct temperature quickly Coat joint surface with flux
and simultaneously, within max. 2-3
minutes to avoid damaging the flux.
Do not heat directly on the filler
material. When the joint has reached
correct temperature the end of the
brazing rod should be touched to the
joint, and the heat from the workpiece
will melt off filler material.
Allow sufficient time for the capillary
action to take full effect. With proper
joints this will happen very quickly.
Keep the workpiece in position until
it has cooled off and the filler has
solidified. The workpiece can then be
released, and if the material allows,
cooled off in water.
Flux residues should be removed to Heat evenly
avoid corrosion.
5.01
506
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Edge preparation
Braze welding
Contrary to the term braze welding is
not a welding process, as the base
material is not melted. The brazing
technique is, however, similar to gas
welding with the leftward method, and
the joint types will be similar to gas
welding except that the joint edges
must be rounded off.
Braze welding may be used to join a
wide range of metals, and is also used
for rebuilding wear surfaces. As with
Use the leftward technique for braze
capillary brazing the surfaces must welding.
be cleaned and correct flux should be
applied where required.
The joint should be preheated
sufficiently before filler material is
applied and melted off with the flame.
When the applied drop of filler flows
outwards, wetting the workpiece
surface correct temperature has
been reached, and brazing may I-joint Below 3 mm.
proceed using the forehand technique
described under gas welding.
Brazing applications
on pipes.
507
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
TIN 241 AG
Description:
Flux cored soft solder wire on spool for tinning and joining of electric
conductors, electrical connections, electrical instruments, radios, batteries,
refrigeration plants, etc.
Packaging Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product no
data mm mm per package per package kg per package
1.5 - - 0.5 093-777973
Neutral.
AG-60-252
Description:
A flux coated cadmium free, seawater resistant, high strength silver rod for
joining all types of steel, stainless steel, copper, copper alloys, nickel, nickel
alloys, cast iron, Yorcalbro pipes (aluminiumbrass), cunifer pipes type 90/10 and
70/30.
Packaging Diameter Length Quantity Net weight Product no
data mm mm per package per package kg per package
2.0 500 24 0.5 093-233601
Flux AG-60/45 Flux 252 PF (250g container)
Product no. 093-778461
On Yorcalbro: Neutral.
ALBRO FLUX 263 PF (250 g container)
5.01 Product no. 093-604371
508
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
BRONZE-264
Description
An easy-flowing, universal brazing bronze (brass) rod for the brazing of steel,
cast iron, copper and copper alloys, nickel and nickel alloys. It gives a very
smooth and attractive surface. The addition of Si, Mn and Sn guarantees a
strong and high-quality deposit.
Neutral or
slight oxygen
surplus.
FC-BRONZE-261
Description
A flux-coated brazing rod for joining and surfacing copper, brass, bronze,
aluminium bronze, cast iron and steel. May be used for brazing galvanized steel
without destroying the galvanized surface.
Neutral or
slight oxygen
surplus.
5.01
Detailed information on these consumables can be found under the section
Consumables.
509
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
FC-WEARBRO-262
Description
A flux-coated wear-resistant bronze rod used for applying a hard-wearing
surface to bronze, brass, copper, steel, cast iron and malleable cast iron. Also
used for braze welding cast iron.
Neutral or
slight oxygen
surplus.
FC-CASTIRON-268S
Description
Flux coated rod for joining and surfacing cast iron and brazing cast iron to
steel. Oil impregnated cast iron may also be brazed with FC-Castiron 268.
Packaging
Diameter Length Rods Net weight Product no.
data
Mm mm per package per package kg per package
4 500 12 0.7 096-682310
5.01
510
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
Argon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513
Argon-Carbon Dioxide mixture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
Carbon Dioxide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515
Oxygen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516
Acetylene . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 518
Rules &Safety precautions for handling and use of Gas cylinders 522
Gas Distribution System for Acetylene and Oxygen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
5.02
511
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
Introduction
Where and how to obtain supplies of the gases needed or
board ship can be a great problem. There are cylinders of many
different types on the market, and an even greater variety of
types of valve and threaded connectors. An extra difficulty is that
most countries have their own rules for the filling and inspection
of cylinders, and this often means that only cylinders of the
countrys own types can be serviced in a reasonable time.
A sure way to avoid difficulties is to join Wilhelmsen Ships
Service's world-wide Unitor gas supply system. Through this
system, ready-filled gas cylinders are available in more than
1600 ports throughout the world. In these ports we have obtained
official permission to refill our own cylinders. In some places,
even with this permission, the filling routines can take great deal
of time. But this is no problem for our customers, as we make
sure of always having enough full cylinders in stock, ready to
meet each customers immediate needs.
Our standardized gas cylinders are owned, inspected and
maintained by Wilhelmsen Ships Service. The cylinders are
delivered to our customers under deposit conditions and can be
returned to Wilhelmsen Ships Service or other authorized agent
5.02 when they are empty.
512
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
Argon
Product name Formula Hazard class
Argon Ar Nonflammable gas
Appearance and colour IMDGcode
Cylinder characteristics
Colour code: Body Grey
Cylinder Outlet Nominal Filled Pressure Nominal Approx. Approx.
Size Connection Contents (bar) at 15C Wt. Of Gas Dimensions Cylinder Wt.
(cu. Metres) (max) (kg) (mm) (kg)
(See note 1.) (See note 1.) (See note 2.) (See note 3.)
E-10 W24.32mm x 1/14 2.2 200 3.6 140 x 1000 18
E-50 W24.32mm x 1/14 11 200 18 230 x 1690 81
Note:
1. Actual contents and weight of gas in individual cylinders will vary about the nominal
contents and weight of gas indicated.
2. The length includes an allowance of 70mm for a top outlet valve.
3. The approximate cylinder weight includes cylinder, valve and neck-ring. The
approximate weight of a full cylinder is obtained by adding the nominal weight
of contained gas to this figure. Greater weights may be found among cylinders
manufactured to older standards.
Argon
Argon is a colourless, odourless gas, slightly heavier than air. It is non-toxic and non-
combustible. Together with Helium, Neon, Krypton, Xenon and Radon, it constitutes a special
group of gases known as the rare, inert or noble gases. The terms inert and noble
mean that the gases have an extremely weak tendency to react with other compounds or
elements. Argon forms no known chemical compounds.
Argon is present in the atmosphere at a concentration of 0.934% at sea level. Air is the only
known source for the production of pure argon.
Argon is non-toxic, but it is included among the simple asphyxiant gases. Argon is used as
a protective shielding gas in TIG and MIG welding. In this process argon serves as an inert
covering round the point of the electrode/ wire and the molten pool in order to protect the
welding zone from the harmful effect of the air. 5.02
513
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
Cylinder characteristics
Colour code: Body Grey/Yellow
Cylinder Outlet Nominal Filled Pressure Nominal Approx. Approx.
Size Connection Contents (bar) at 15C Wt. Of Gas Dimensions Cylinder Wt.
(cu. Metres) (max) (kg) (mm) (kg)
(See note 1.) (See note 1.) (See note 2.) (See note 3.)
M-10 W24.32mm x 1/14 2.2 200 3.4 140 x 1000 18
M-50 W24.32mm x 1/14 10.9 200 17.1 230 x 1690 81
Note:
1. Actual contents and weight of gas in individual cylinders will vary about the nominal
contents and weight of gas indicated.
2. The length includes an allowance of 70mm for a top outlet valve.
3. The approximate cylinder weight includes cylinder, valve and neck-ring. The
approximate weight of a full cylinder is obtained by adding the nominal weight
of contained gas to this figure. Greater weights may be found among cylinders
manufactured to older standards.
514
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
CARbon dioxide
Product name Formula Hazard class
Carbon dioxide CO2 Nonflammable gas
Appearance and colour IMDGcode
Cylinder characteristics
Colour code: Body Grey
Cylinder Outlet Nominal Nominal Approx. Approx.
Size Connection Contents Wt. Of Gas Dimensions Cylinder Wt.
(cu. Metres) (kg) (mm) (kg)
(See note 1.) (See note 2.) (See note 3.)
C-9 CgA320 4.95 9 203 x 560 19
C-27 CgA320 14.85 27 230 x 1210 55
Note:
1. Actual contents and weight of gas in individual cylinders will vary about the
nominal contents and weight of gas indicated.
2. The length includes an allowance of 70mm for a top outlet valve.
3. The approximate cylinder weight includes cylinder and valve.
The approximate weight of a full cylinder is obtained by adding the nominal
weight of contained gas to this figure.
Carbon dioxide
Carbon dioxide is a colourless, odourless gas, slightly heavier than air. It is non-toxic and
non-combustible.
It is considered a inert gases. The terms inert mean that the gases have an extremely weak
tendency to react with other compounds or elements.
Carbon dioxide is present in the atmosphere at a concentration of 0.04% at sea level. It is
produced by burning fossil fuels or chemical reactions.
Carbon dioxide is non-toxic at low concentration but it is included among the simple
asphyxiate gases. Concentrations above 5% are considered as dead threatening.
Carbon dioxide is used as a protective shielding gas in MAG welding. In this process carbon
dioxide serves as an active gas covering round the point of the electrode/ wire and the
molten pool in order to protect the welding zone from the harmful effect of the air.
It is additionally greatly used in the food and beverage industry either as a protective gas to
conserve food products or carbonation of soft drinks and beers. A new application is water 5.02
treatment to balance the acidity of potable water.
515
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
Oxygen
Product name Formula Hazard class
Oxygen O2 Nonflammable gas
Appearance and colour IMDGcode
Cylinder characteristics
Colour code: Body Blue
Cylinder Outlet Nominal Filled Pressure Nominal Approx. Approx.
Size Connection Contents (bar) at 15C Wt. Of Gas Dimensions Cylinder Wt.
(cu. Metres) (max) (kg) (mm) (kg)
(See note 1.) (See note 1.) (See note 2.) (See note 3.)
0-5 W21.80mm x 1/14 1 200 1.3 140 x 620 12
0-40 W21.80mm x 1/14 6.4 150 7.8 230 x 1360 52
Note:
1. Actual contents and weight of gas in individual cylinders will vary about the nominal
contents and weight of gas indicated.
2. The length includes an allowance of 70mm for a top outlet valve.
3. The approximate cylinder weight includes cylinder, valve and neck-ring. The
approximate weight of a full cylinder is obtained by adding the nominal weight
of contained gas to this figure. Greater weights may be found among cylinders
manufactured to older standards.
Oxygen
Oxygen (02) is a colourless, odourless gas, slightly heavier than air. Oxygen normally amounts
to 21% by volume of the earths atmosphere at sea level. Oxygen is produced industrially by
rectification (distillation) of liquid air, from which the Oxygen boils off at minus 183 C, and can thus
be separated from the other air gases, for compression in steel cylinders.
Oxygen itself will not burn, but the gas sustains combustion in the normal sense of the word. In
pure oxygen combustion proceeds much more rapidly than in air, and the higher the pressure,
the more violent the combustion. Even materials that are normally not combustible, or are difficult
to ignite, can catch fire spontaneously or be set alight in pure Oxygen. We make use of this
phenomenon for the Oxygen-cutting of steel.
Oxygen can lead to the explosive ignition of ordinary oil, grease or other organic substances. For
this reason a welder must never wear working clothes or use equipment that is contaminated with
5.02 oil or grease. Be particularly careful to prevent equipment or fittings for Oxygen to come in contact
with oil or grease. Only special lubricants may be used for Oxygen equipment.
516
AC/OXCUTTING/WELDING/BRAZING
517
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
ACETYLENE
Product name Formula Hazard class
Acetylene C2H2 Flammable gas
Appearance and odour IMDGcode
Cylinder characteristics
Acetylene (Dissolved in a solvent supported in a porous medium) Colour: Maroon.
Cylinder Outlet Nominal Nominal Approx. Approx.
Size Connection Contents Wt. Of Gas Dimensions Cylinder Wt.
(cu. Metres) (kg) (mm) (kg)
(See note 1.) (See note 1.) (See note 2.) (See note 3.)
A-5 G 3/4 BSP 0.7 0.8 140 x 620 14
A-40 G 3/4 BSP 5.6 6.2 230 x 1360 67
Note:
1. Actual contents and weight of gas in individual cylinders will vary about
the nominal contents and weight of gas indicated.
2. The length includes an allowance of 70mm for a top outlet valve.
3. The approximate cylinder weight includes cylinder, valve and neck-ring.
The approximate weight of a full cylinder is obtained by adding the nominal
weight of contained gas to this figure. Greater weights may be found
5.02 among cylinders manufactured to older standards.
518
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
Acetylene
Acetylene is a colourless, flammable, kept handy. Should the flame make
and in the pure state odourless closing of the top valve difficult or
gas. It is can be manufactured by impossible, it must first be put out by
reacting Calcium Carbide with water a Carbon Dioxide (CO2) or dry powder
in Acetylene generators. Ordinary extinguisher.
commercial grades of Acetylene Another property, which should be
contain traces of impurities such as known and understood by personnel
Phosphine, Arsine, Hydrogen Sulfide engaged in transporting or using
and Ammonia, and have a garlic-like Acetylene is that the gas can
odour. The gas is slightly lighter than decompose into its constituents,
air. Carbon and Hydrogen, if it is exposed
Acetylene alone burns in air with to temperatures above 350C (662F)
a very hot, bright and sooty flame. or if gaseous Acetylene at a pressure
Mixed with air or Oxygen in the of more than 2 bar (200 kPa; 29 psig)
right proportion, Acetylene gives a is subjected to shock during storage
concentrated, sootfree flame. When or transportation. Decomposition
mixed with Oxygen the combustion is proceeds rapidly and liberates a
more intense than in air, and because great deal of energy. Because of this
of the Acetylenes high carbon content property, Acetylene cannot be stored
(92.3% by weight) its maximum flame under pressure in the same way, for
temperature is about 3100C. Because example, that Oxygen is stored.
of its high temperature, thermal value To avoid the decomposition
and speed of combustion (11.6 m/s), characteristics of compressed,
this is the most suitable gas flame gaseous Acetylene the cylinders for
both for welding and for cutting. storing the gas are filled with a porous
mass, having minute cellular spaces.
Explosion and decomposition hazards This eliminates the risk that any
Acetylene, is a highly flammable pocket of appreciable size remains, in
and explosive gas, and a mixture which Acetylene in gaseous form may
of Acetylene and air or Oxygen is collect. The porous mass is saturated
explosive within wide limits. The with Acetone, in which the Acetylene
explosive limits in air range from 2% actually dissolves. The combination
to 82%, while if mixed with Oxygen of these features - porous mass and
the explosive range is from 2.5% to solvent allows the Acetylene to be
93%. For this reason care must be contained in cylinders at moderate
taken to prevent an unnecessary or pressure with greatly reduced danger
uncontrolled escape of Acetylene, and of explosive decomposition occuring
good ventilation must be assured in during normal handling and use.
places where Acetylene is stored or However, there still exists the chance
used. that decomposition may be started
Should escaping Acetylene from an by careless handling of the cylinder,
open top valve or from the regulator, such as hitting or dropping it, heating
catch fire, put out the flame by closing it, or by using incomplete or badly
the top valve. For this eventuality a maintained welding equipment,
fire-resistant mitten should always be thereby permitting a complete flash- 5.02
519
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
back of the welding flame into the longer be touched by the bare hand
cylinder. The signs of decomposition (more than about 50 C), the danger
are: of an explosion is imminent and the
The temperature of the cylinder cylinder must not be moved. Start
cooling the cylinder immediately with
shell rises, starting at the area
large amounts of cold water from a
within which the decomposition
protected position. All personnel not
commenced.
The cylinder pressure increases taking part in this operation must be
evacuated from the area. When the
(only evident when the cylinder is in
cylinder has been cooled until the
use and a regulator with gauges is
water no longer steams from the shell,
fitted on the top valve).
If, after a complete flash-back, the it can be moved to the railing and
thrown over board. Remember that
gas released from the top valve
cooling must be continued without
contains soot, and has an unusual
interruption throughout the removal
smell.
operation.
On suspicion that decomposition may
have started in the cylinder, shut the WARNING: The top valve of a
top valve immediately, and remove cylinder containing decomposing
regulator or other fittings attached to Acetylene must be kept shut at all
it. The cylinder must be checked for times!
increase in temperature by repeatedly
feeling the cylinder shell all over by Fatal mistakes have been made in
hand. cases of this kind; even experienced
If temperature of the shell rises, but welders have opened the cylinder
has not exceeded hand-heat (about valve fully, in the mistaken belief
50C) the cylinder must be taken to that this would release the pressure
the railing immediately and thrown in the cylinder. In fact, the opposite
over board. The cylinder must be happens. The Acetylene that
cooled by copius amounts of water evaporates out of the Acetone passes
while it is being moved. If the ship is the decomposition zone on its way to
in port, hang the cylinder by a rope the top valve, decomposition becomes
into the sea and call the fire brigade. explosive and the pressure in the
cylinder increases much faster than
It is possible to stop a decomposition
it can be released, with the result
by keeping the top valve closed
that the cylinder may explode within
and cooling the cylinder with large
seconds.
quantities of cold water, but if this is
to succeed it must be commenced
at the latest five minutes after the Inhalation hazards
decomposition has started, and must Acetylene is a non-toxic but mildly
continue until the cylinder remains anesthetic gas. Formerly pure
cold. However, out of consideration Acetylene was combined with
for the crew and the ship, do not try Oxygen and used as an anesthetic
to save the cylinder but throw it over in hospitals. There is a risk of
board as quickly as possible. asphyxia when the Acetylene level
If decomposition has reached a in respiratory air reduces the Oxygen
5.02
point where the cylinder can no content to three-fourths or less of
520
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
521
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
5.02
522
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
WARNING
It is extremely dangerous, and
therefore forbidden, to attempt to
transfer oxygen or acetylene from one
cylinder to another on ones own.
Filling of gas cylinders shall be carried
out only by qualified personnel at the
filling factories.
Failure to observe this rule has
unfortunately led to the loss of several
lives.
5.02
523
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
5.02
524
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
525
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
central gas storage. If any important screw with a locknut for pressure
component of the system is damaged, regulation. When the correct pressure
changed or replaced, the system has been set on the regulator (8 bar
shall be inspected again and a new for oxygen and 0.8 bar for acetylene),
installation certificate issued. the setting is locked by tightening the
locknut. This makes it unnecessary to
reset the pressures every time the plant
The layout of the central system is used, the gas flow being controlled
The layout of the central system and simply by opening and closing the shut-
various components are shown in off valve (9).
the drawing on the next page. The The desired working pressure is
central store where the cylinders are set by means of a regulating valve
kept must be situated on or above at the outlet station, as required for
the upper continuous deck, and it the individual welding and cuffing
must have access to the open deck. operations. The safety valve of
The door to the central store must be the central regulator (11) must be
marked with a notice warning of gas connected to a pipe to carry any
under pressure. escaping gas out to the open deck.
Fastening arrangements (3) for the The end of this pipe must be located
number of Acetylene and Oxygen not less than 3 metres above deck,
cylinders to be kept on board are and the outlet must be marked with
to be welded to the bulkhead. The a regulation sign as follows: Gas
design of the fastening clamps makes danger. Fire, open lights and smoking
it very easy to release the cylinders in prohibited.
case of a fire. From the cylinders the From the low-pressure side of the
gas is carried through high-pressure regulator the gas is fed through a
hoses (4) to T-valves (6).
low-pressure steel expansion pipe
The connection nuts for the high- (12) and connected to the permanent
pressure hoses are right-hand piping system serving the outlet
threaded for Oxygen and left-hand stations by means of an outlet union
threaded for Acetylene, to eliminate (16). The pipelines are colour-coded.
the possibility of the hoses being Blue pipes are for Oxygen and red for
wrongly connected. Non-return Acetylene.
valves (5) are fitted to prevent gas Where a pipe passes through
from flowing back through the T-valve bulkheads or decks it must be led
to the gas cylinders. through bushings (18), and the pipes
By using several T-valves connected are to be fastened to bulkheads with
by expansion pipes (8) it is possible to pipe clamps (17) at intervals of about
connect in series any desired number 2.5 metres. The outlet stations are
of cylinders. The last T-valve in the to be installed at suitable locations
series is closed with a blind plug and which are well ventilated and where
connecting nut (7). From the T-valves the outlet station is protected from
the gas is led to a shut-off valve (9) mechanical damage. If necessary, the
where the central regulator R520(10) is outlet may be placed in a protective
located. The regulator has an adjusting cabinet (25).
5.02
526
GASSUPPLIESANDGASDISTRIBUTIONSYSTEM
Outlet stations on open decks must from time to time. Also fitted at the
always be enclosed in protective outlet station are regulators to set
cabinets. Each outlet station is fitted the desired working pressure (21),
with shut-off valves (20) which should flashback arrestors (22) for Acetylene
be closed during short interruptions and Oxygen, and gauges for working
in work. pressure (23). In addition to the
flashback arrestors, the welding torch
NOTE: There is a filter in the threaded
should be fitted with nonreturn valves
inlet union for the shut-off valve of
to prevent reverse flows and the
the gas pipeline, to prevent particles
mixing of welding gases in the hoses.
passing into the outlet fittings. In time
See separate chapter on nonreturn
this filter can become clogged; it
valves.
should be unscrewed for inspection
5.02
527
WELDINGHANDBOOKNOTES
5.02
528
miscellaneous information
6.00
529
miscellaneous information
6.00
530
miscellaneous information
THEPHONETICALPHABET
A B C D E F G H I
Alpha Bravo Charlie Delta Echo Foxtrot Golf Hotel India
J K L M N O P Q R
Juliet Kilo Lima Mike November Oscar Papa Quebec Romeo
S T U V W X Y Z
Sierra Tango Uniform Victor Whiskey X-ray Yankee Zulu
THEGREEKALPHABET
6.00
531
miscellaneous information
Linear Measure
mil (0,001 inch) millimetre 0,0254 39,37
inch millimetre 25,4 0,03937
foot metre 0,3048 3,281
yard metre 0,9144 1,0936
mile kilometre 1,6093 0,6214
nautical mile kilometre 1,8532 0,5396
Square Measure
square inch square millimeter 645,2 0,00155
square inch square centimeter 6,452 0,155
square foot square metre 0,0929 10,764
square yard square metre 0,8361 1,196
acre square metre 4047, 0,0002471
acre square foot 43560, 0,00002296
square mile acre 640, 0,001562
square mile square kilometer 2,590 0,3863
Volume
cubic inch cubic centimeter 16,387 0,06102
cubic foot cubic metre 0,02832 35,31
cubic foot gallon (U.S.) 7,48 0,1337
cubic foot litre 28,32 0,03531
cubic yard cubic metre 0,7646 1,3079
ounce (U.S., liq.) cubic centimeter 29,57 0,03382
quart (U.S., liq.) litre 0,9464 1,0566
gallon (U.S.) gallon (Imperial) 0,8327 1,2009
gallon (U.S.) litre 3,785 0,2642
barrel (U.S.Petroleum) gallon (U.S.) 42, 0,0238
barrel (U.S.Petroleum) litre 158,98 0,00629
Mass
grain milligram 64,8 0,01 543
ounce (oz) gram 28,35 0,03527
pound (lbs) kilogram 0,4536 2,205
short ton metric ton 0,9072 1,1023
long ton metric ton 1,0161 0,9842
Pressure or Stress
pound force per inch2 (psi) pascal 6895, 0,0001450
kip per inch2 (ksi) megapascal 6,895 0,145
pound force per inch2 (psi) bar 0,06895 14,50
kip per inch2 kilogram per millimetre2 0,7031 1,4223
atmosphere mm Hg 760, 0,001316
atmosphere pound force per inch2 14,696 0,06805
6.00
532
miscellaneous information
Miscellaneous
pound per gallon (U.S.) gram per litre 119,8 0,00835
pound mole (gas) cubic foot (STP) 359, 0,00279
gram mole (gas) litre (STP) 22,4 0,0446
board foot cubic metre 0,00236 423,7
milliampere per foot2 milliampere per metre2 10,76 0,0929
gallons (U.S.) per minute metre3 per day 5,451 0,1835
pound-force newton 4,448 0,2248
kilopond (Kp) newton (N) 9,81 0,102
Roman Numerals
Basic numerals: I V X L C D M
1 5 10 50 100 500 1000
Combination rules:
A smaller numeral in front of a larger is subtracted from the larger
A smaller numeral after a larger is added to the larger
Equal numerals after each other are added together
II and III are never placed in front of a larger numeral, e.g. 7 is always VII, never IIIX
A horizontal line above a numeral multiplies this numeral with 1000. A horizontal line
above together with a vertical line on each side of the numeral multiplies the numeral
with 100.000.
6.00
533
miscellaneous information
Thickness in mm
AI(U.S.)
Copper
Brass Galv. Stainless Steel
Gauge B&S Iron Al(U.K.) Steel Sheet Strip Zinc
No. AWG GSG SWG MSG USG BWG AZG
7/0 12,7
6/0 11,8
5/0 11,0
4/0 10,2
3/0 9,4
2/0 8,8
1/0 8,2
1 7,34 7,62 7,14
2 6,55 7,01 6,75
3 5,82 6,40 6,07 6,35 0,15
4 5,18 5,89 5,69 5,95 0,20
5 4,62 5,38 5,31 5,56 0,25
6 4,11 4,88 4,93 5,16 0,30
7 3,66 4,47 4,55 4,76 4,57 0,36
8 3,25 4,27 4,06 4,17 4,37 4,19 0,41
9 2,90 3,89 3,66 3,78 3,97 3,76 0,46
10 2,59 3,50 3,25 3,40 3,57 3,40 0,51
11 2,31 3,18 2,95 3,05 3,18 3,05 0,61
12 2,06 2,79 2,64 2,67 2,78 2,77 0,71
13 1,83 2,41 2,34 2,29 2,38 2,41 0,81
14 1,63 2,03 2,03 1,90 1,98 2,11 0,91
15 1,45 1,80 1,83 1,70 1,79 1,83 1,02
16 1,30 1,63 1,63 1,52 1,59 1,65 1,14
17 1,14 1,47 1,42 1,37 1,42 1,47 1,27
18 1,02 1,32 1,22 1,22 1,27 1,24 1,40
19 0,91 1,17 1,02 1,07 1,11 1,07 1,52
20 0,81 1,02 0,91 0,91 0,95 0,89 1,78
21 0,71 0,94 0,81 0,84 0,87 0,81 2,03
22 0,64 0,86 0,71 0,76 0,79 0,71 2,29
23 0,58 0,79 0,61 0,69 0,71 0,64 2,54
24 0,51 0,71 0,56 0,61 0,64 0,56 3,18
25 0,46 0,64 0,51 0,53 0,56 0,51 6,35
6.00
535
miscellaneous information
* kg/Nm3
** Liquid, at boiling point -37C
6.00
536
miscellaneous information
Note: These numbers correspond with the numbers and alloy designations
listed in the left column.
6.00
538
miscellaneous information
6.00
539
miscellaneous information
Temperature Scales
0 C = 273,15 K= 0 Re
= 32 F = 491,67 R
100 C = 373,15 K = 80 Re
= 212 F = 671,67 R
t = 5/9 (tf 32)
t = 5/4 tre
t = T273,15
t = 5/9TR 273,15
tf = 9/5t+32
tf = TR 459,67
tf = 9/4(tre +32)
T = t +273,15
T = 5/9 tf + 255,37
T = 5/9 TR
TR = tf + 459,67
TR = 9/5t+491,67
TR = 9/5 T
6.00
540
miscellaneous information
6.00
541
miscellaneous information
6.00
542
miscellaneous information
6.00
543
miscellaneous information
6.00
544
miscellaneous information
6.00
545
miscellaneous information
6.00
546
miscellaneous information
INERT GAS Gas that does not normally combine chemically with
the base metal or filler material. Also referred to as
nobel gas.
INTERMITTANCE See duty cycle.
INTERPASS In multiple pass weld, minimum and maximum
TEMPERATURE temperature specified for the deposited metal before
next weld pass is started.
INVERTER Welding power source were the normal frequency is
set to a very high value thereby reducing the need for a
heavy iron core in order to reduce the voltage.
ISO Abbreviation for International Standardization
Organisation.
KILLED STEEL Steel which contains fairly large quantities of
ferrosilicium or aluminium. This type of steel is suitable
for welded connections.
LOW ALLOY STEEL Steel containing 15% alloy elements.
LR Lloyds Register of Shipping (British classification
institute).
MAGNETIC ARC
BLOW See Arc Blow.
MAG-WELDING Metal Active Gas-welding. (see also GMAW).
MANGANESE An important alloy in steel, melting point 1245 C.
Chemical symbol Mn.
MARTENSITE Structure obtained when steel is heated and cooled to
achieve its maximum hardness.
MIG-WELDING Metal Inert Gas-welding. See also Gas Shielded Arc
Welding and GMAW.
MILD STEEL Unalloyed steel, maximum carbon content 0.25%.
MPa Mega Pascal
NDT-TESTS Abbreviation for Non-Destructive Testing, i.e. testing
and investigation materials or components without
destroying these. Involves use of radiography,
supersonic testing, magnetic powder, penetrating fluids
etc.
NON-RETURN VALVE An appliance fitted on the outlet of the regulator of a
gas cylinder which prevent any flame from a backfire in
the welding torch from returning to the gas cylinder.
6.00
547
miscellaneous information
6.00
548
miscellaneous information
6.00
549
miscellaneous information
6.00
550
marine products
Marine Chemicals
safety
maritime logistics
ships agency
Id no. 804012, Printer: Brdr. Fossum, 8K. 03.13. Country of origin NO. All reasonable care has been
taken in compiling the information in this document. All recommendations and suggestions on the use
of Unitor products are made without guarantee since the conditions of use are beyond the control
of the Company. It is the customers responsibility to ensure that each product is fit for its intended
purpose and that the actual conditions of use are suitable. This book and any advice is provided by
Wilhelmsen Ships Service accordingly on terms that no liability (including liability for negligence) will
attach to the Company or its servants or agents arising out of or in connection with or in relation to
this brochure or any such advice. Any goods supplied by the Company will be supplied solely upon
its standard conditions of sale, copies of which are available on request. The Companys policy of
continuous product development renders specifications liable to modification. Information provided in
this book is therefore subject to change without prior notification.